blob: e6ea2cfc8945e2b17b1e4cf27a115cf274140f85 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau0e658fb2016-11-25 16:55:50 +01005 version 1.8
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau7b677262017-04-03 09:27:49 +02007 2017/04/03
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111
1121. Quick reminder about HTTP
113----------------------------
114
115When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
116fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
117on almost anything found in the contents.
118
119However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
120formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
121correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
122
123
1241.1. The HTTP transaction model
125-------------------------------
126
127The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100128to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
130connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
131will involve a new connection :
132
133 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
134
135In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
136establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
137by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
138length.
139
140Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
141to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
142however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
143response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
144header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
145
146 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
147
148Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
149power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
150but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200151a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152
153A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
154keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
155second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
156page :
157
158 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
159
160This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
161latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
162correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
163the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100164server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100166By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
167connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
168leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
169start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200170
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100171HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
172 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
173 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
174 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
175 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
176 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
177 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179
1801.2. HTTP request
181-----------------
182
183First, let's consider this HTTP request :
184
185 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100186 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
188 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
189 3 User-agent: my small browser
190 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
191 5 Accept: image/png
192
193
1941.2.1. The Request line
195-----------------------
196
197Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
198
199 - a METHOD : GET
200 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
201 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
202
203All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
204which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
205followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
206is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
207desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
208the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
209
210The URI itself can have several forms :
211
212 - A "relative URI" :
213
214 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
217 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
218
219 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
220
221 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
222
223 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
224 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
225 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
226 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
227 must accept this form too.
228
229 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
230 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
231 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100232
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200233 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
234 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
235 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
236 other protocols too.
237
238In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
239mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
240on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
241It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
242specific to the language, framework or application in use.
243
244
2451.2.2. The request headers
246--------------------------
247
248The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
249beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
250an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
251Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
252values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
253encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
254the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
255define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
256
257Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
258their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
259"Connection:" header).
260
261The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
262that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
263is one valid form of empty line.
264
265Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
266headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
267about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
268application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
269
270Important note:
271 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
272 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
273 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
274 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
275
276
2771.3. HTTP response
278------------------
279
280An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
281messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
282
283 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100284 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
286 2 Content-length: 350
287 3 Content-Type: text/html
288
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200289As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
290codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
291response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100292continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
293the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
294following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
295sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
296(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
297correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
298such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
299state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
300over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
301if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
302information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304
3051.3.1. The Response line
306------------------------
307
308Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
309
310 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
311 - a status code : 200
312 - a reason : OK
313
314The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200315 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
317 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
318 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
319 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
320
321Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
324messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
325or "Authentication Required".
326
327Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
328
329 Code When / reason
330 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
331 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
332 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
333 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100334 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
335 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200336 400 for an invalid or too large request
337 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
338 accessing the stats page)
339 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
340 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
341 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
342 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
343 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
344 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
345 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
346 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
347 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
348
349The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3504.2).
351
352
3531.3.2. The response headers
354---------------------------
355
356Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
357the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
358details.
359
360
3612. Configuring HAProxy
362----------------------
363
3642.1. Configuration file format
365------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200366
367HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
368
369 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
370 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
371 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
372 "frontend" and "backend".
373
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100374The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
375referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200376delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003792.2. Quoting and escaping
380-------------------------
381
382HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
383many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
384with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
385single quotes.
386
387If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
388them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
389escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
390
391Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
392
393 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
394 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
395 \\ to use a backslash
396 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
397 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
398
399Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
400the interpretation of:
401
402 space as a parameter separator
403 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
404 # hash as a comment start
405
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200406Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
407-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
408backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
409
410Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200411quoting.
412
413Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
414nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
415
416Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
417equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
418
419 Example:
420 # those are equivalents:
421 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
422 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
423 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
424 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
425 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
426
427 # those are equivalents:
428 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
430 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
431 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
432
433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004342.3. Environment variables
435--------------------------
436
437HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
438interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
439configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
440optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
441shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
442underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
443
444 Example:
445
446 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
447
448 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
449
450 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
451
452
4532.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200454----------------
455
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100456Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100457values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
458otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
459numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
460for every keyword. Supported units are :
461
462 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
463 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
464 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
465 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
466 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
467 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
468
469
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00004702.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200471-------------
472
473 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
474 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
475 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
476 global
477 daemon
478 maxconn 256
479
480 defaults
481 mode http
482 timeout connect 5000ms
483 timeout client 50000ms
484 timeout server 50000ms
485
486 frontend http-in
487 bind *:80
488 default_backend servers
489
490 backend servers
491 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
492
493
494 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
495 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
496 global
497 daemon
498 maxconn 256
499
500 defaults
501 mode http
502 timeout connect 5000ms
503 timeout client 50000ms
504 timeout server 50000ms
505
506 listen http-in
507 bind *:80
508 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
509
510
511Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
512
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100513 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200514
515
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005163. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517--------------------
518
519Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
520are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
521of them have command-line equivalents.
522
523The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
524
525 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200526 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200527 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200528 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200529 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200530 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200531 - description
532 - deviceatlas-json-file
533 - deviceatlas-log-level
534 - deviceatlas-separator
535 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900536 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200537 - gid
538 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100539 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200540 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200541 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100542 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200543 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544 - nbproc
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200545 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200546 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100547 - presetenv
548 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200549 - uid
550 - ulimit-n
551 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100552 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200553 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200554 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
555 - ssl-default-bind-options
556 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
557 - ssl-default-server-options
558 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100559 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100560 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100561 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100562 - 51degrees-data-file
563 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200564 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200565 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100566 - wurfl-data-file
567 - wurfl-information-list
568 - wurfl-information-list-separator
569 - wurfl-engine-mode
570 - wurfl-cache-size
571 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100572
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200573 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200574 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200575 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200576 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100577 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100578 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100579 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200580 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200581 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200582 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200583 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200584 - noepoll
585 - nokqueue
586 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100587 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300588 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000589 - noreuseport
Olivier Houchard1fc05162017-04-06 01:05:05 +0200590 - no-unused-socket
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200591 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200592 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200593 - server-state-file
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200594 - tune.buffers.limit
595 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200596 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200597 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100598 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100599 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200600 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100601 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100602 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100603 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100604 - tune.lua.session-timeout
605 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200606 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100607 - tune.maxaccept
608 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200609 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200610 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200611 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100612 - tune.rcvbuf.client
613 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100614 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100615 - tune.sndbuf.client
616 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100617 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100618 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200619 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100620 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200621 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200622 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100623 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200624 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100625 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200626 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
627 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
628 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100629 - tune.zlib.memlevel
630 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100631
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200632 * Debugging
633 - debug
634 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200635
636
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006373.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200638------------------------------------
639
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200640ca-base <dir>
641 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200642 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
643 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200644
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645chroot <jail dir>
646 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
647 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
648 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
649 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
650 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
651 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100652
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100653cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
654 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
655 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
656 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100657 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
658 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
659 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
660 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
661 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
662 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
663 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
664 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
665 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
666 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100667
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200668crt-base <dir>
669 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
670 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
671 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
672
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200673daemon
674 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
675 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
676 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
677
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200678deviceatlas-json-file <path>
679 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
680 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
681
682deviceatlas-log-level <value>
683 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
684 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
685
686deviceatlas-separator <char>
687 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
688 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
689
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100690deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200691 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
692 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
693 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100694
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900695external-check
696 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
697 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
698 See "option external-check".
699
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200700gid <number>
701 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
702 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
703 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100704 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
705 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200706 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100707
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100708hard-stop-after <time>
709 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
710
711 Arguments :
712 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
713 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
714 SIGUSR1 signal.
715
716 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
717 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
718 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
719
720 Example:
721 global
722 hard-stop-after 30s
723
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200724group <group name>
725 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
726 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100727
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200728log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200729 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
730 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100731 configured with "log global".
732
733 <address> can be one of:
734
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100735 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100736 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
737 port).
738
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100739 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
740 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
741 port).
742
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100743 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
744 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
745 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
746 writeable).
747
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200748 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
749 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100750
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200751 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
752 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
753 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
754 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
755 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
756 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
757 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
758 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
759 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
760 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
761 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
762
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200763 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
764 one of the following :
765
766 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
767 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
768
769 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
770 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
771
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100772 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200773
774 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
775 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
776 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
777
778 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200779 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
780 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
781 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
782 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
783 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
784 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200785
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200786 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200787
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100788log-send-hostname [<string>]
789 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
790 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
791 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
792 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
793 the logs.
794
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000795log-tag <string>
796 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
797 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
798 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100799 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000800
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100801lua-load <file>
802 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
803 used multiple times.
804
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200805nbproc <number>
806 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
807 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
808 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
809 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
810 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
811
812pidfile <pidfile>
813 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
814 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
815 starting the process. See also "daemon".
816
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100817presetenv <name> <value>
818 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
819 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
820 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
821 and "unsetenv".
822
823resetenv [<name> ...]
824 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
825 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
826 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
827 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
828 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
829 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
830 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
831 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
832
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100833stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200834 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
835 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
836 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
837 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
838 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
839 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100840 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200841 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
842 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200843
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200844server-state-base <directory>
845 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200846 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
847 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200848
849server-state-file <file>
850 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
851 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
852 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
853 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
854 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
855 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
856 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
857 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200858 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
859 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200860
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100861setenv <name> <value>
862 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
863 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
864 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
865 and "unsetenv".
866
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100867ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
868 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
869 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300870 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100871 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
872 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
873 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
874 "bind" keyword for more information.
875
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100876ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
877 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
878 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
879 keyword to see available options.
880
881 Example:
882 global
883 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
884
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100885ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
886 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
887 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300888 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100889 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
890 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
891 information.
892
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100893ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
894 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
895 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
896 keyword to see available options.
897
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200898ssl-dh-param-file <file>
899 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
900 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
901 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
902 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
903 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200904 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
905 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
906 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
907 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200908 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
909 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
910 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
911
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100912ssl-server-verify [none|required]
913 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
914 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
915 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
916
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200917stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
918 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
919 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
920 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +0200921 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
922 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200923
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200924 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
925 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
926 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200927
928stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
929 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
930 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100931 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200932
933stats maxconn <connections>
934 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
935 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
936
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200937uid <number>
938 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
939 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
940 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
941 one. See also "gid" and "user".
942
943ulimit-n <number>
944 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
945 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
946 option.
947
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100948unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
949 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
950
951 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
952 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
953 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
954 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
955 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
956 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
957 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
958 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
959 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
960 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
961
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100962unsetenv [<name> ...]
963 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
964 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
965 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
966 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
967 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
968 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
969 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
970
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200971user <user name>
972 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
973 See also "uid" and "group".
974
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200975node <name>
976 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
977
978 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
979 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
980 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
981 traffic.
982
983description <text>
984 Add a text that describes the instance.
985
986 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
987 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
988 "<" and ">" characters.
989
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +010099051degrees-data-file <file path>
991 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
992 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
993
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200994 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100995 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
996
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000099751degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100998 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
999 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1000 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1001
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001002 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001003 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1004
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200100551degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001006 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1007 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1008
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001009 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1010 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1011
101251degrees-cache-size <number>
1013 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1014 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1015 By default, this cache is disabled.
1016
1017 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001018 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1019
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001020wurfl-data-file <file path>
1021 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1022 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1023
1024 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1025 with USE_WURFL=1.
1026
1027wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1028 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1029 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1030 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1031
1032 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1033
1034 Valid WURFL properties are:
1035 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1036
1037 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1038 device.
1039
1040 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1041 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1042
1043 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1044 particular web request.
1045
1046 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1047 used Libwurfl API version.
1048
1049 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1050 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1051 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1052
1053 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1054 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1055
1056 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1057 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1058
1059 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1060
1061 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1062
1063 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1064 with USE_WURFL=1.
1065
1066wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1067 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1068 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1069
1070 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1071 with USE_WURFL=1.
1072
1073wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1074 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1075 thus before the chroot.
1076
1077 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1078 with USE_WURFL=1.
1079
1080wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1081 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1082 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
1083 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
1084 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
1085 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
1086 mode is enabled by default.
1087
1088 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1089 with USE_WURFL=1.
1090
1091wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1092 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1093 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1094 - "0" : no cache is used.
1095 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1096 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1097 the highest performing option.
1098
1099 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1100 with USE_WURFL=1.
1101
1102wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1103 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1104 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1105
1106 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1107 with USE_WURFL=1.
1108
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001109
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011103.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001111-----------------------
1112
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001113max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1114 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1115 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1116 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1117 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1118 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1119 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1120 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1121 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1122
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001123maxconn <number>
1124 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1125 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1126 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001127 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1128 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1129 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1130 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001131 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1132 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1133 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1134 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1135 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001136
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001137maxconnrate <number>
1138 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1139 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1140 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1141 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1142 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1143 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1144 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1145 fairness.
1146
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001147maxcomprate <number>
1148 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001149 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001150 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1151 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1152 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1153 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1154 default value.
1155
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001156maxcompcpuusage <number>
1157 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1158 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1159 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1160 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1161 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1162 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1163 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1164 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1165
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001166maxpipes <number>
1167 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1168 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1169 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1170 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1171 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1172 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1173
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001174maxsessrate <number>
1175 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1176 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1177 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1178 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1179 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1180 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1181 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1182 fairness.
1183
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001184maxsslconn <number>
1185 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1186 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1187 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1188 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1189 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1190 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1191 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001192 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1193 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1194 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1195 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1196 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1197 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1198 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001199
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001200maxsslrate <number>
1201 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1202 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1203 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1204 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1205 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1206 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1207 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1208 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1209 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1210 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1211
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001212maxzlibmem <number>
1213 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1214 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1215 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001216 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1217 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1218 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1219
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001220noepoll
1221 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1222 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001223 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001224
1225nokqueue
1226 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1227 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1228 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1229
1230nopoll
1231 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1232 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001233 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001234 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001235
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001236nosplice
1237 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1238 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1239 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001240 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001241 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1242 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1243 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1244 "option splice-response".
1245
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001246nogetaddrinfo
1247 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1248 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1249
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001250noreuseport
1251 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1252 command line argument "-dR".
1253
Olivier Houchard1fc05162017-04-06 01:05:05 +02001254no-unused-socket
1255 By default, each haproxy process keeps all sockets opened, event those that
1256 are only used by another processes, so that any process can provide all the
1257 sockets, to make reloads seamless. This option disables this, and close all
1258 unused sockets, to save some file descriptors.
1259
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001260spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001261 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1262 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1263 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1264 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1265 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1266 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001267
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001268tune.buffers.limit <number>
1269 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1270 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1271 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1272 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1273 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1274 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1275 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1276 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1277 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1278 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1279 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1280 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1281 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1282 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1283 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1284
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001285tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1286 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1287 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1288 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1289 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1290
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001291tune.bufsize <number>
1292 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1293 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1294 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1295 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1296 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1297 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1298 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1299 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001300 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1301 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1302 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001303
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001304tune.chksize <number>
1305 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1306 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1307 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1308 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1309 checks whenever possible.
1310
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001311tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1312 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1313 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1314 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1315 this value. The default value is 1.
1316
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001317tune.http.cookielen <number>
1318 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1319 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1320 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1321 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1322 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1323 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1324 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1325 to change this value.
1326
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001327tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1328 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1329 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1330 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1331 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1332 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1333 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1334 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1335 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1336 limit too high.
1337
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001338tune.idletimer <timeout>
1339 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1340 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1341 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1342 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1343 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1344 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1345 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1346 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1347 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1348
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001349tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1350 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001351 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001352 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1353 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1354 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1355 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1356 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1357
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001358tune.lua.maxmem
1359 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1360 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1361 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1362 memory.
1363
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001364tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1365 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001366 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1367 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1368 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001369
1370tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1371 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1372 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1373 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1374 check servers.
1375
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001376tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1377 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1378 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1379 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1380 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1381
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001382tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001383 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1384 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1385 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1386 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1387 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1388 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1389 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1390 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1391 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1392 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001393
1394tune.maxpollevents <number>
1395 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1396 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1397 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1398 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1399 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1400
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001401tune.maxrewrite <number>
1402 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1403 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1404 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1405 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1406 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1407 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1408 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1409 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1410 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1411 bufsize.
1412
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001413tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1414 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1415 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1416 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1417 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1418 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1419 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1420 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1421 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1422 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1423 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1424 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1425 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1426 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1427 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1428 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1429 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1430 setting this parameter to 0.
1431
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001432tune.pipesize <number>
1433 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1434 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1435 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1436 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1437 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1438 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1439
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001440tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1441tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1442 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1443 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1444 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1445 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1446 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1447 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1448 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1449
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001450tune.recv_enough <number>
1451 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1452 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1453 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1454 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1455 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1456
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001457tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1458tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1459 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1460 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1461 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1462 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1463 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1464 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1465 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1466 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1467 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1468 notifying haproxy again.
1469
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001470tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001471 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1472 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1473 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001474 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001475 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1476 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1477 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1478 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1479 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001480 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1481 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001482
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001483tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1484 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1485 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1486 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1487 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1488 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1489 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1490
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001491tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1492 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001493 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001494 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1495 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1496 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1497 being used for too long.
1498
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001499tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1500 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1501 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1502 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1503 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1504 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1505 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1506 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1507 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1508 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1509 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001510 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1511 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001512
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001513tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1514 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1515 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1516 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1517 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1518 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1519 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1520 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001521 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1522 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001523
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001524tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1525 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1526 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1527 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1528 1000 entries.
1529
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001530tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1531 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1532 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1533 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1534
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001535tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001536tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001537tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1538tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1539tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001540 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1541 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1542 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1543 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1544 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1545 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1546 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1547 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001548
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001549 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1550 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1551 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1552 all available space is consumed.
1553 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1554 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1555 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001556
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001557tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1558 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001559 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001560 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1561 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1562 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1563
1564tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1565 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1566 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1567 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1568 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001569
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015703.3. Debugging
1571--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001572
1573debug
1574 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1575 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1576 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1577 system startup.
1578
1579quiet
1580 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1581 line argument "-q".
1582
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001583
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015843.4. Userlists
1585--------------
1586It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1587http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1588it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1589
1590userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001591 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001592 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1593
1594group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001595 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001596 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1597 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1598
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001599user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1600 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001601 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1602 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001603 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1604 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001605 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001606 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001607
1608
1609 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001610 userlist L1
1611 group G1 users tiger,scott
1612 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001613
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001614 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1615 user scott insecure-password elgato
1616 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001617
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001618 userlist L2
1619 group G1
1620 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001621
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001622 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1623 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1624 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001625
1626 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001627
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001628
16293.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001630----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001631It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1632several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1633instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1634values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1635automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1636In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1637using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1638tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1639reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1640Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1641that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1642each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001643
1644peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001645 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001646 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1647
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001648disabled
1649 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1650 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1651 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1652
1653enable
1654 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1655
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001656peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1657 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1658 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1659 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1660 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1661 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1662 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1663
1664 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1665 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1666
1667 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1668 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1669 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1670 across all peers.
1671
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001672 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1673 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001674
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001675 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001676 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001677 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1678 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1679 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001680
1681 backend mybackend
1682 mode tcp
1683 balance roundrobin
1684 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1685 stick on src
1686
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001687 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1688 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001689
1690
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090016913.6. Mailers
1692------------
1693It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1694If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1695in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1696
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001697mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001698 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1699 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1700
1701mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1702 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1703
1704 Example:
1705 mailers mymailers
1706 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1707 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1708
1709 backend mybackend
1710 mode tcp
1711 balance roundrobin
1712
1713 email-alert mailers mymailers
1714 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1715 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1716
1717 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1718 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1719
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001720timeout mail <time>
1721 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1722 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1723 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1724 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1725
1726 Example:
1727 mailers mymailers
1728 timeout mail 20s
1729 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001730
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017314. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001732----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001733
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001734Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001735 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001736 - frontend <name>
1737 - backend <name>
1738 - listen <name>
1739
1740A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1741its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1742section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001743section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001744
1745A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1746connections.
1747
1748A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1749to forward incoming connections.
1750
1751A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1752parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1753
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001754All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1755'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1756case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1757
1758Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1759logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1760proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1761However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1762name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1763
1764Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1765and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001766bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001767protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1768modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1769arbitrary criteria.
1770
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001771In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1772a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1773the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1774
1775 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1776 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1777 between responses and new requests.
1778
1779 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1780 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1781 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1782 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1783
1784 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1785 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1786 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1787
1788 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1789 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1790 client-facing connection remains open.
1791
1792 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1793 after the end of the response.
1794
1795The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1796frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1797following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1798weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1799
1800 Backend mode
1801
1802 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1803 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1804 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1805 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1806 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1807 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1808 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1809 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1810 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1811 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1812 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1813
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001814
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001815
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018164.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1817--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001818
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001819The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1820limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1821they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1822limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001823marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001824option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001825and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1826with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1827specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001828
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001829
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001830 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1831------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1832acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001833appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001834backlog X X X -
1835balance X - X X
1836bind - X X -
1837bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02001838block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001839capture cookie - X X -
1840capture request header - X X -
1841capture response header - X X -
1842clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001843compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001844contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1845cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001846declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001847default-server X - X X
1848default_backend X X X -
1849description - X X X
1850disabled X X X X
1851dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001852email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001853email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001854email-alert mailers X X X X
1855email-alert myhostname X X X X
1856email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001857enabled X X X X
1858errorfile X X X X
1859errorloc X X X X
1860errorloc302 X X X X
1861-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1862errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001863force-persist - X X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001864filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001865fullconn X - X X
1866grace X X X X
1867hash-type X - X X
1868http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001869http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001870http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001871http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001872http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001873http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001874http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001875id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001876ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001877load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001878log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001879log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001880log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001881log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001882max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001883maxconn X X X -
1884mode X X X X
1885monitor fail - X X -
1886monitor-net X X X -
1887monitor-uri X X X -
1888option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1889option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1890option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1891option allbackups (*) X - X X
1892option checkcache (*) X - X X
1893option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1894option contstats (*) X X X -
1895option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1896option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1897option forceclose (*) X X X X
1898-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1899option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001900option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001901option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001902option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001903option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001904option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001905option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001906option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001907option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1908option httpchk X - X X
1909option httpclose (*) X X X X
1910option httplog X X X X
1911option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001912option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001913option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001914option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001915option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1916option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1917option logasap (*) X X X -
1918option mysql-check X - X X
1919option nolinger (*) X X X X
1920option originalto X X X X
1921option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02001922option pgsql-check X - X X
1923option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001924option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001925option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001926option smtpchk X - X X
1927option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1928option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1929option splice-request (*) X X X X
1930option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01001931option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001932option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1933option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1934-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001935option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001936option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1937option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1938option tcpka X X X X
1939option tcplog X X X X
1940option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001941external-check command X - X X
1942external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001943persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1944rate-limit sessions X X X -
1945redirect - X X X
1946redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1947redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1948reqadd - X X X
1949reqallow - X X X
1950reqdel - X X X
1951reqdeny - X X X
1952reqiallow - X X X
1953reqidel - X X X
1954reqideny - X X X
1955reqipass - X X X
1956reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001957reqitarpit - X X X
1958reqpass - X X X
1959reqrep - X X X
1960-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001961reqtarpit - X X X
1962retries X - X X
1963rspadd - X X X
1964rspdel - X X X
1965rspdeny - X X X
1966rspidel - X X X
1967rspideny - X X X
1968rspirep - X X X
1969rsprep - X X X
1970server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001971server-state-file-name X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001972source X - X X
1973srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02001974stats admin - X X X
1975stats auth X X X X
1976stats enable X X X X
1977stats hide-version X X X X
1978stats http-request - X X X
1979stats realm X X X X
1980stats refresh X X X X
1981stats scope X X X X
1982stats show-desc X X X X
1983stats show-legends X X X X
1984stats show-node X X X X
1985stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001986-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1987stick match - - X X
1988stick on - - X X
1989stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001990stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01001991stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001992tcp-check connect - - X X
1993tcp-check expect - - X X
1994tcp-check send - - X X
1995tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001996tcp-request connection - X X -
1997tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001998tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02001999tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002000tcp-response content - - X X
2001tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002002timeout check X - X X
2003timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002004timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002005timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2006timeout connect X - X X
2007timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2008timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2009timeout http-request X X X X
2010timeout queue X - X X
2011timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002012timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002013timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2014timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002015timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002016transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002017unique-id-format X X X -
2018unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002019use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002020use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002021------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2022 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002023
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002024
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020254.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2026---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002027
2028This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2029
2030
2031acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2032 Declare or complete an access list.
2033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2034 no | yes | yes | yes
2035 Example:
2036 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2037 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2038 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2039
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002040 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002041
2042
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002043appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2044 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002045 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2047 no | no | yes | yes
2048 Arguments :
2049 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2050 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2051
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002052 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002053 checked in each cookie value.
2054
2055 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2056 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2057 milliseconds.
2058
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002059 request-learn
2060 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2061 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2062 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2063 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2064 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2065 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2066
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002067 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2068 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2069 data following this prefix.
2070
2071 Example :
2072 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2073
2074 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
2075 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
2076
2077 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2078 2 modes are currently supported :
2079 - path-parameters :
2080 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2081 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2082 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2083 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2084 - query-string :
2085 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2086 query string.
2087
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002088 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2089 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2090 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002091
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002092 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2093 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002094
2095
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002096backlog <conns>
2097 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2099 yes | yes | yes | no
2100 Arguments :
2101 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2102 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002103 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002104
2105 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2106 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2107 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2108 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2109 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2110 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2111 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2112 backlog parameter.
2113
2114 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2115 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2116 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2117
2118 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2119
2120
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002121balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002122balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002123 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2125 yes | no | yes | yes
2126 Arguments :
2127 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2128 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2129 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2130 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2131
2132 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2133 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2134 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2135 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002136 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002137 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002138 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2139 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2140 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2141 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2142 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2143 it, so that you don't worry.
2144
2145 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2146 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2147 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2148 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2149 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2150 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2151 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2152 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002153
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002154 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2155 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2156 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2157 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2158 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2159 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2160 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2161 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2162
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002163 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002164 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002165 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2166 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002167 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002168 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2169 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2170 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2171 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2172 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002173 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2174 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2175 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2176 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2177 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2178 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002179
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002180 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2181 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2182 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2183 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2184 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2185 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2186 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2187 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002188 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002189 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002190 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2191 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2192 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002193
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002194 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2195 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2196 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2197 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2198 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2199 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2200 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2201 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2202 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2203 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2204 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2205 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002206
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002207 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002208 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2209 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2210 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2211 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2212 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2213 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2214 URIs start with a leading "/".
2215
2216 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2217 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2218 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2219 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2220
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002221 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002222 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2223
2224 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002225 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2226 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002227 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2228 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2229 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2230 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002231 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002232 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2233 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002234
2235 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2236 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2237 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2238 server will receive the request.
2239
2240 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2241 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2242 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2243 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2244 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002245 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2246 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2247 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002248
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002249 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2250 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2251 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2252 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2253 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002254
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002255 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002256 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2257 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2258 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2259
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002260 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2261 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2262 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2263
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002264 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002265 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002266 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2267 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2268 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2269 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2270 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2271 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002272 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002273 used instead.
2274
2275 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2276 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2277 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2278 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2279
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002280 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2281 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2282 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2283
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002284 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002285
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002286 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002287 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2288 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002289
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002290 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2291 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2292 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002293
2294 Examples :
2295 balance roundrobin
2296 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002297 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002298 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2299 balance hdr(host)
2300 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002301
2302 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2303 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2304
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002305 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002306 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2307 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2308 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2309 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2310
2311 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2312 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2313 defaults to 16 kB.
2314
2315 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2316 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2317
2318 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2319 Round Robin.
2320
2321 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
2322 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2323 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2324 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2325
2326 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2327
2328 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002329 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002330 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2331 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2332 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002333
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002334 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002335
2336
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002337bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2338bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002339 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2341 no | yes | yes | no
2342 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002343 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2344 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2345 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2346 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002347 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002348 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2349 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2350 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2351 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2352 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2353 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2354 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002355 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2356 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2357 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2358 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2359 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2360 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2361 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002362 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2363 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2364 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002365 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2366 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2367 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002368
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002369 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2370 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002371 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2372 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2373 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002374 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2375 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2376 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2377 the range.
2378
2379 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2380 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2381 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2382 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2383 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2384 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2385 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002386 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002387 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002388
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002389 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2390 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2391 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2392 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2393 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2394 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2395 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2396 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2397
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002398 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2399 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2400 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2401 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002402
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002403 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2404 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2405 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2406 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2407 in a frontend.
2408
2409 Example :
2410 listen http_proxy
2411 bind :80,:443
2412 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002413 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002414
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002415 listen http_https_proxy
2416 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002417 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002418
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002419 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2420 bind ipv6@:80
2421 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2422 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2423
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002424 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002425 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002426
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002427 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2428 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2429 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2430 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2431 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2432
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002433 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002434 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002435
2436
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002437bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002438 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2440 yes | yes | yes | yes
2441 Arguments :
2442 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2443 may be used to override a default value.
2444
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002445 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002446 option may be combined with other numbers.
2447
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002448 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002449 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2450 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2451 missing from all processes.
2452
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002453 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002454 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002455 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2456 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2457 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2458 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002459
2460 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2461 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2462 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2463 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2464 and 'even' instances.
2465
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002466 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2467 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2468 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2469 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002470
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002471 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2472 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2473
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002474 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2475 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2476 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2477
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002478 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2479 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2480
2481 Example :
2482 listen app_ip1
2483 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002484 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002485
2486 listen app_ip2
2487 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002488 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002489
2490 listen management
2491 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002492 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002493
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002494 listen management
2495 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2496 bind-process 1-4
2497
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002498 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002499
2500
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002501block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002502 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2504 no | yes | yes | yes
2505
2506 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2507 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002508 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002509 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002510 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2511 "block" statements per instance.
2512
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002513 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2514 "http-request deny" instead.
2515
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002516 Example:
2517 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2518 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2519 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002520 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2521 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2522 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002523
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002524 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002525
2526
2527capture cookie <name> len <length>
2528 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2530 no | yes | yes | no
2531 Arguments :
2532 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2533 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2534 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2535 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2536 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2537
2538 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2539 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2540 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2541 right if it exceeds <length>.
2542
2543 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2544 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2545 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2546 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2547
2548 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2549 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2550 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2551
2552 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2553 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2554 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002555 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2556 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2557 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002558
2559 Example:
2560 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2561
2562 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002563 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002564
2565
2566capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002567 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2569 no | yes | yes | no
2570 Arguments :
2571 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002572 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002573 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2574 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2575 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2576
2577 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2578 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2579 it exceeds <length>.
2580
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002581 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002582 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2583 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002584 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2585 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2586 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2587 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002588 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002589 environments to find where the request came from.
2590
2591 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2592 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2593 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2594 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002595
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002596 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2597 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2598 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2599 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2600 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002601
2602 Example:
2603 capture request header Host len 15
2604 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002605 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002606
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002607 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002608 about logging.
2609
2610
2611capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002612 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2614 no | yes | yes | no
2615 Arguments :
2616 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002617 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002618 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2619 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2620 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2621
2622 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2623 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2624 it exceeds <length>.
2625
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002626 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002627 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2628 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2629 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002630 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2631 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2632 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2633 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002634
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002635 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2636 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2637 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2638 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2639 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002640
2641 Example:
2642 capture response header Content-length len 9
2643 capture response header Location len 15
2644
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002645 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002646 about logging.
2647
2648
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002649clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002650 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2652 yes | yes | yes | no
2653 Arguments :
2654 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2655 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2656 as explained at the top of this document.
2657
2658 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2659 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2660 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2661 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2662 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2663 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2664 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2665 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002666 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002667 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2668 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2669
2670 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2671 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2672 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2673 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2674 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2675 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2676
2677 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2678 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2679
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002680 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2681 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002682
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002683compression algo <algorithm> ...
2684compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002685compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002686 Enable HTTP compression.
2687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2688 yes | yes | yes | yes
2689 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002690 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2691 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2692 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2693
2694 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002695 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2696 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2697 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002698
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002699 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002700 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002701
2702 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2703 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2704 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2705 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2706 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002707 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002708
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002709 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2710 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2711 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2712 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2713 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2714 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2715 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002716 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002717
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002718 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002719 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002720 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2721 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2722 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2723 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2724 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002725
2726 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2727 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2728 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2729 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2730 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002731 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2732 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2733 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2734 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2735 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002736 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2737 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002738
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002739 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002740 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2741 "Accept-Encoding" header
2742 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002743 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002744 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2745 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002746 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2747 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2748 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2749 "multipart"
2750 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2751 header
2752 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2753 and later
2754 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2755 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002756
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002757 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2758 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002759
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002760 Examples :
2761 compression algo gzip
2762 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002763
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002764
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002765contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002766 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2768 yes | no | yes | yes
2769 Arguments :
2770 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2771 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2772 as explained at the top of this document.
2773
2774 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002775 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002776 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002777 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2778 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2779 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2780 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2781
2782 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2783 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2784 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2785 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2786 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2787 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2788
2789 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2790 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2791 instead.
2792
2793 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2794 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2795
2796
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002797cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002798 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2799 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01002800 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002801 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2803 yes | no | yes | yes
2804 Arguments :
2805 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2806 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2807 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2808 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2809 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2810 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2811 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2812 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2813 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2814
2815 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2816 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2817 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2818 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2819 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2820 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002821 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2822 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2823 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2824 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2825 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002826
2827 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002828 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002829
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002830 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002831 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2832 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2833 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2834 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2835 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2836 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2837 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2838 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2839 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2840 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002841
2842 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2843 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2844 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2845 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2846 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2847 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2848 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2849 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2850 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002851 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002852 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2853 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2854 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002855
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002856 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2857 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2858 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002859 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2860 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2861 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2862 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002863 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2864 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2865 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002866
2867 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2868 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2869 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2870 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2871 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2872 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2873 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2874 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2875 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2876
2877 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2878 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2879 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2880 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2881 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2882 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2883 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2884 persistence cookie in the cache.
2885 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2886
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002887 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2888 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2889 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2890 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2891 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2892 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2893 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2894 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2895 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2896 they logout.
2897
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002898 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2899 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2900 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2901 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2902
2903 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2904 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2905 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2906 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2907 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2908 this attribute.
2909
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002910 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002911 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002912 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2913 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2914 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2915 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2916 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2917 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002918
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002919 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2920 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2921 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2922 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2923 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2924 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2925 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2926 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2927 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2928 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2929 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2930 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2931 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2932 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2933 the site.
2934
2935 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2936 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2937 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2938 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2939 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2940 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2941 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2942 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2943 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2944 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2945 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2946 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2947 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2948 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2949 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2950 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2951
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01002952 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
2953 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
2954 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
2955 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
2956 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
2957 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
2958
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002959 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2960 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2961 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2962 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002963
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002964 Examples :
2965 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2966 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2967 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002968 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002969
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002970 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002971
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002972
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002973declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2974 Declares a capture slot.
2975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2976 no | yes | yes | no
2977 Arguments:
2978 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2979
2980 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2981 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2982 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2983 for use in the response.
2984
2985 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02002986 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002987 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2988
2989
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002990default-server [param*]
2991 Change default options for a server in a backend
2992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2993 yes | no | yes | yes
2994 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002995 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2996 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2997 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2998 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002999
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003000 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003001 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3002
3003 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003004
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003005
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003006default_backend <backend>
3007 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3008 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3009 yes | yes | yes | no
3010 Arguments :
3011 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3012
3013 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3014 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3015 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3016 will catch all undetermined requests.
3017
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003018 Example :
3019
3020 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3021 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3022 default_backend dynamic
3023
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003024 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003025
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003026
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003027description <string>
3028 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3030 no | yes | yes | yes
3031 Arguments : string
3032
3033 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3034 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3035 it describes.
3036 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3037
3038
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003039disabled
3040 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3042 yes | yes | yes | yes
3043 Arguments : none
3044
3045 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3046 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3047 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3048 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3049 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3050 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3051 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3052
3053 See also : "enabled"
3054
3055
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003056dispatch <address>:<port>
3057 Set a default server address
3058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3059 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003060 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003061
3062 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3063 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3064 during start-up.
3065
3066 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3067 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3068 possible with normal servers.
3069
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003070 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003071 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3072 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3073 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3074 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3075
3076 See also : "server"
3077
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003078
3079dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3080 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3082 yes | no | yes | yes
3083 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3084
3085 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
3086 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitely
3087 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3088 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
3089 That way, we can ensure session persistence accross multiple load-balancers,
3090 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003091
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003092enabled
3093 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3095 yes | yes | yes | yes
3096 Arguments : none
3097
3098 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3099 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3100
3101 See also : "disabled"
3102
3103
3104errorfile <code> <file>
3105 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3107 yes | yes | yes | yes
3108 Arguments :
3109 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04003110 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
3111 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003112
3113 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003114 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003115 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003116 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3117 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003118
3119 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3120 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3121 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3122
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003123 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3124
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003125 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3126 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3127 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3128 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3129
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003130 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3131 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
3132 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
3133 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3134 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3135 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3136
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003137 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3138 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3139 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003140 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003141 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3142
3143 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3144
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003145 Example :
3146 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003147 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003148 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3149 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3150
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003151
3152errorloc <code> <url>
3153errorloc302 <code> <url>
3154 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3156 yes | yes | yes | yes
3157 Arguments :
3158 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003159 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003160
3161 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3162 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3163 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3164 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3165 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3166
3167 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3168 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3169 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3170
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003171 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3172
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003173 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3174 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3175 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3176 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003177 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003178 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3179 request.
3180
3181 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3182
3183
3184errorloc303 <code> <url>
3185 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3187 yes | yes | yes | yes
3188 Arguments :
3189 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
3190 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3191
3192 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3193 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3194 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3195 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3196 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3197
3198 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3199 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3200 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3201
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003202 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3203
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003204 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3205 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3206 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3207 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003208 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003209
3210 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3211
3212
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003213email-alert from <emailaddr>
3214 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3215 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3216 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3217 yes | yes | yes | yes
3218
3219 Arguments :
3220
3221 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3222
3223 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3224 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3225
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003226 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003227 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3228 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003229
3230
3231email-alert level <level>
3232 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3233 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3234 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3235 yes | yes | yes | yes
3236
3237 Arguments :
3238
3239 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3240 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3241 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3242
3243 By default level is alert
3244
3245 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3246 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3247 for the proxy.
3248
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003249 Alerts are sent when :
3250
3251 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3252 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3253 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3254 is notice or lower
3255 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3256 and a health check status update occurs
3257
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003258 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3259 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003260 section 3.6 about mailers.
3261
3262
3263email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3264 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3265 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3266 yes | yes | yes | yes
3267
3268 Arguments :
3269
3270 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3271
3272 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3273 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3274
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003275 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3276 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003277
3278
3279email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3280 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3281 mailers.
3282 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3283 yes | yes | yes | yes
3284
3285 Arguments :
3286
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003287 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003288
3289 By default the systems hostname is used.
3290
3291 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3292 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3293 for the proxy.
3294
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003295 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3296 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003297
3298
3299email-alert to <emailaddr>
3300 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3301 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3302 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3303 yes | yes | yes | yes
3304
3305 Arguments :
3306
3307 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3308
3309 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3310 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3311
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003312 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003313 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3314
3315
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003316force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3317 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3318 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3319 no | yes | yes | yes
3320
3321 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3322 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3323 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3324 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3325 marked down for maintenance operations.
3326
3327 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3328 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3329 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3330 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3331 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3332 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3333 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3334 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3335 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3336
3337 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3338 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3339 is used.
3340
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003341 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003342 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003343
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003344
3345filter <name> [param*]
3346 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3348 no | yes | yes | yes
3349 Arguments :
3350 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3351 referenced in section 9.
3352
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003353 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003354 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003355 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3356 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003357
3358 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3359 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3360
3361 Example:
3362 listen
3363 bind *:80
3364
3365 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3366 filter compression
3367 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3368
3369 compression algo gzip
3370 compression offload
3371
3372 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3373
3374 See also : section 9.
3375
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003376
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003377fullconn <conns>
3378 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3380 yes | no | yes | yes
3381 Arguments :
3382 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3383 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3384
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003385 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003386 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003387 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003388 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3389 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3390 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3391 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3392 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003393 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003394
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003395 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3396 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003397 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3398 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3399 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003400
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003401 Example :
3402 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3403 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3404 # connections.
3405 backend dynamic
3406 fullconn 10000
3407 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3408 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3409
3410 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3411
3412
3413grace <time>
3414 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003416 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003417 Arguments :
3418 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3419 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3420 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3421
3422 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3423 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003424 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003425 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3426
3427 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3428 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3429 simplify it.
3430
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003431
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003432hash-balance-factor <factor>
3433 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3435 yes | no | no | yes
3436 Arguments :
3437 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3438 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3439 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3440
3441 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3442 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3443 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3444 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3445 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3446 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3447 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3448
3449 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3450 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3451 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3452 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3453 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3454
3455 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3456
3457
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003458hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003459 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3461 yes | no | yes | yes
3462 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003463 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3464 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003465
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003466 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3467 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3468 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3469 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3470 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3471 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3472 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3473 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3474 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3475 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003476
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003477 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3478 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3479 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3480 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3481 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3482 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3483 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3484 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3485 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3486 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3487 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3488 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3489 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003490 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3491 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003492
3493 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3494
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003495 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003496 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3497 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3498 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003499 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3500 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3501 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003502
3503 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3504 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003505 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3506 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3507 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3508 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3509
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003510 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3511 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3512 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3513 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3514 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3515 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3516 parameter.
3517
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003518 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3519 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3520 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3521 used on strings.
3522
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003523 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3524
3525 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3526 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3527 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3528 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3529 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3530 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3531 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3532 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3533 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3534 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3535 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3536 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003537
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003538 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3539 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3540 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003541
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003542 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003543
3544
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003545http-check disable-on-404
3546 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003548 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003549 Arguments : none
3550
3551 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3552 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3553 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3554 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3555 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3556 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3557 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3558 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003559 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3560 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3561 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3562
3563 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3564
3565
3566http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003567 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003569 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003570 Arguments :
3571 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3572 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003573 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003574 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3575 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3576 details on the supported keywords.
3577
3578 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3579 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3580 with the usual backslash ('\').
3581
3582 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3583 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3584 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3585 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3586 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3587
3588 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003589 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003590 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3591 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3592 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3593
3594 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003595 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003596 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3597 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3598 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3599 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3600
3601 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003602 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003603 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3604 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3605 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3606 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3607 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3608 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3609 trace).
3610
3611 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003612 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003613 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3614 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3615 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3616 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3617 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3618 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3619
3620 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3621 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3622 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3623 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3624 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3625 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3626 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3627 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3628
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003629 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3630 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3631 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3632
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003633 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3634 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3635
3636 Examples :
3637 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003638 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003639
3640 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003641 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003642
3643 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003644 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003645
3646 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03003647 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003648
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003649 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003650
3651
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003652http-check send-state
3653 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3655 yes | no | yes | yes
3656 Arguments : none
3657
3658 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3659 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3660 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3661 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3662 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3663
3664 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3665 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3666 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3667 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3668 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003669 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3670 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3671 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3672
3673 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3674 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3675 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3676
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003677 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3678 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3679 checked in multiple backends.
3680
3681 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3682 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3683
3684 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3685 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3686 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3687 one fails.
3688
3689 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3690 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3691 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3692
3693 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3694 server's queue.
3695
3696 Example of a header received by the application server :
3697 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3698 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3699
3700 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3701
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003702http-request { allow | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
3703 tarpit [deny_status <status>] | deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003704 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003705 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003706 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003707 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3708 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003709 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3710 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003711 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3712 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3713 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003714 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003715 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01003716 unset-var(<var name>) |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003717 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003718 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003719 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003720 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003721 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003722 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003723 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3724
3725 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3726 no | yes | yes | yes
3727
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003728 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3729 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3730 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3731 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3732 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003733
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003734 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3735 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3736 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3737
3738 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003739 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3740 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3741 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3742 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003743
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003744 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3745 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3746 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003747 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status
3748 code specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003749 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3750 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3751 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3752 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3753 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003754 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003755 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3756 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003757
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003758 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3759 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3760 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3761 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3762 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3763
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003764 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3765 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3766 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003767 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3768 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003769
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003770 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3771 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3772 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3773 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3774 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3775 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3776 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3777 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3778
3779 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3780 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3781 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003782 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3783 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003784
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003785 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3786 <name>.
3787
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003788 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3789 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3790 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3791 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3792 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3793 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3794 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3795 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3796
3797 Example:
3798
3799 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3800
3801 applied to:
3802
3803 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3804
3805 outputs:
3806
3807 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3808
3809 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3810
3811 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3812 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3813 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3814 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3815 header.
3816
3817 Example:
3818
3819 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3820
3821 applied to:
3822
3823 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3824
3825 outputs:
3826
3827 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3828
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003829 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3830 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3831 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3832 it.
3833
3834 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3835 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3836 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3837 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3838 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3839 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3840
3841 Example :
3842 # prepend the host name before the path
3843 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3844
3845 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3846 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3847 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3848 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3849 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3850 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3851 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3852 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3853
3854 Example :
3855 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3856 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3857
3858 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3859 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3860 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3861 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3862 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3863 "set-query".
3864
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003865 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3866 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3867 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3868 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3869 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3870 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3871 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3872 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3873
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003874 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3875 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3876 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3877 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3878 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3879 another equipment.
3880
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003881 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3882 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3883 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3884 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3885 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3886 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3887 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3888 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3889
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003890 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3891 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3892 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3893 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3894 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3895 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3896 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3897 admin privileges.
3898
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003899 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3900 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3901 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3902 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3903 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3904 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3905 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3906 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3907
3908 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3909 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3910 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3911 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3912 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3913 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3914
3915 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3916 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3917 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3918 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3919 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3920 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3921
3922 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3923 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3924 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3925 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3926 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3927 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3928 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3929 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3930 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3931
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003932 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003933 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3934 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3935 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3936 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3937 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3938 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3939 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3940 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3941 request header" for more information.
3942
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003943 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3944 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3945 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3946 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01003947 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
3948 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003949
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003950 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3951 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3952 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3953 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3954 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3955 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3956 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3957 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3958 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3959 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3960 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3961 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3962
3963 These actions take one or two arguments :
3964 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3965 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3966 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3967 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3968
3969 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3970 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3971 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3972 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3973
3974 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3975 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3976 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3977 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3978 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3979 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3980 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3981 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3982
3983 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3984 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3985 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3986 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3987 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3988
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003989 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
3990 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
3991 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
3992 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
3993 continues.
3994
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003995 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
3996 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
3997 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
3998 the actions evaluation continues.
3999
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004000 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
4001 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4002 inline.
4003
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004004 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4005 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004006 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004007 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4008 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004009 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004010 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004011 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004012 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4013 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004014 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004015 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004016 and '_'.
4017
4018 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4019 followed by some converters.
4020
4021 Example:
4022
4023 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
4024
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004025 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4026 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4027
4028 Example:
4029
4030 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
4031
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004032 - set-src <expr> :
4033 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4034 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
4035 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4036 source IP for privacy.
4037
4038 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4039 followed by some converters.
4040
4041 Example:
4042
4043 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4044 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4045
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004046 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4047 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004048
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004049 - set-src-port <expr> :
4050 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4051 expression.
4052
4053 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4054 followed by some converters.
4055
4056 Example:
4057
4058 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4059 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4060
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004061 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
4062 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
4063 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004064
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004065 - set-dst <expr> :
4066 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4067 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
4068 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4069 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4070 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4071
4072 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4073 followed by some converters.
4074
4075 Example:
4076
4077 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4078 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
4079
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004080 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
4081 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
4082
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004083 - set-dst-port <expr> :
4084 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4085 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4086 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4087
4088 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4089 followed by some converters.
4090
4091 Example:
4092
4093 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4094 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
4095
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004096 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4097 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4098 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4099
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004100 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4101 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4102 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4103 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4104 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4105 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4106 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4107 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4108 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4109 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4110 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4111 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4112 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4113 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4114 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4115 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4116
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004117 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
4118
4119 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4120 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004121 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4122 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
4123
4124 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4125 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4126 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4127 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004128
4129 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004130 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4131 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4132 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004133
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004134 http-request allow if nagios
4135 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4136 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4137 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004138
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004139 Example:
4140 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004141 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004142
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004143 Example:
4144 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4145 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02004146 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004147 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4148 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4149 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4150 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4151 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4152 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
4153
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004154 Example:
4155 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4156 acl add path /addacl
4157 acl del path /delacl
4158
4159 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4160
4161 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4162 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
4163
4164 Example:
4165 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4166 acl setmap path /setmap
4167 acl delmap path /delmap
4168
4169 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4170
4171 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4172 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
4173
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004174 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4175 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004176
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004177http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004178 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004179 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004180 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
4181 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004182 set-status <status> [reason <str>] |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004183 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
4184 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4185 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4186 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01004187 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004188 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004189 unset-var(<var-name>) |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004190 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004191 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004192 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004193 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004194 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02004195 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004196 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4197
4198 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4199 no | yes | yes | yes
4200
4201 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4202 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4203 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4204 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4205 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4206 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4207
4208 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4209 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4210 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4211 current section.
4212
4213 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4214 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4215 rules are evaluated.
4216
4217 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4218 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4219 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4220 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4221 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4222 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4223 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4224
4225 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4226 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4227 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4228 external users.
4229
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004230 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4231 <name>.
4232
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004233 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4234 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4235 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4236 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4237 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4238 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4239 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4240 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4241
4242 Example:
4243
4244 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4245
4246 applied to:
4247
4248 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4249
4250 outputs:
4251
4252 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4253
4254 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4255
4256 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4257 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4258 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4259 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4260 header.
4261
4262 Example:
4263
4264 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4265
4266 applied to:
4267
4268 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4269
4270 outputs:
4271
4272 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4273
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004274 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004275 be an integer between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be
4276 provided defined by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code
4277 will be used as a fallback.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004278
4279 Example:
4280
4281 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4282 http-response set-status 431
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004283 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4284 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004285
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004286 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4287 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4288 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4289 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4290 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4291 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4292 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4293 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4294
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004295 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4296 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4297 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4298 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4299 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4300 another equipment.
4301
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004302 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4303 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4304 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4305 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4306 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4307 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4308 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4309 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4310
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004311 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4312 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4313 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4314 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4315 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4316 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4317 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4318 admin privileges.
4319
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004320 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4321 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4322 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4323 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4324 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4325 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4326 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4327 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4328
4329 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4330 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4331 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4332 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4333 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4334 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4335
4336 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4337 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4338 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4339 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4340 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4341 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4342
4343 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4344 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4345 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4346 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4347 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4348 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4349 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4350 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4351 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4352
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004353 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4354 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4355 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4356 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4357 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4358 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4359 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4360 response header" for more information.
4361
4362 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4363 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4364 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4365 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4366 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004367 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4368 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004369
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004370 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4371 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4372 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4373 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4374 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4375 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4376
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004377 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4378 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4379 inline.
4380
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004381 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4382 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004383 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004384 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4385 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004386 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004387 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004388 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004389 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4390 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004391 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01004392 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
4393 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004394
4395 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4396 followed by some converters.
4397
4398 Example:
4399
4400 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4401
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004402 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4403 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4404
4405 Example:
4406
4407 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4408
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004409 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4410 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4411 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4412 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
4413 use of samples in response (eg. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4414 Layer 6 (eg. ssl related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
4415 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4416
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004417 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4418 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4419 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4420 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4421 continues.
4422
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004423 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4424 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4425 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4426 the actions evaluation continues.
4427
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004428 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4429 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4430 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4431 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4432 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4433 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4434 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4435 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4436 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4437 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4438 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4439 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4440 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4441 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4442 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4443 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4444
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004445 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4446
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004447 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004448 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4449 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004450 rules.
4451
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004452 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4453 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4454 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4455 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4456
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004457 Example:
4458 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4459
4460 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4461
4462 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4463 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4464
4465 Example:
4466 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4467
4468 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4469
4470 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4471 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4472
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004473 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4474 ACL usage.
4475
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004476
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004477http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4478 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4479
4480 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4481 yes | no | yes | yes
4482
4483 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4484 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4485 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4486 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4487 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4488 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4489
4490 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4491
4492 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4493 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4494 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4495 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4496 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4497 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4498 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4499 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4500 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4501 not checking any request past the first one.
4502
4503 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4504 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4505 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4506 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4507 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4508 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4509 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4510
4511 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4512 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4513 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4514 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4515 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4516 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4517 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4518 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4519 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4520 downsides of rare connection failures.
4521
4522 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4523 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4524 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4525 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4526 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4527 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4528 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4529 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4530 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4531 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4532 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4533 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4534
4535 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4536 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4537 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4538 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4539
4540 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4541 and are never shared ;
4542
4543 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4544 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4545 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4546 and are never shared ;
4547
4548 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4549 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4550 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4551
4552 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4553 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4554 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4555
4556 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4557
4558
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004559http-send-name-header [<header>]
4560 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4561
4562 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4563 yes | no | yes | yes
4564
4565 Arguments :
4566
4567 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4568
4569 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4570 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4571 is added with the header string proved.
4572
4573 See also : "server"
4574
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004575id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004576 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4578 no | yes | yes | yes
4579 Arguments : none
4580
4581 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4582 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4583 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004584
4585
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004586ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4587 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4588 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4589 no | yes | yes | yes
4590
4591 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4592 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4593 and running).
4594
4595 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4596 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4597 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004598 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004599 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4600
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004601 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4602 "unless" condition is met.
4603
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004604 Example:
4605 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
4606 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
4607 ignore-persist if url_static
4608
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004609 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4610
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004611load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4612 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4613 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4614 yes | no | yes | yes
4615
4616 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4617 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4618 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4619 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4620 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4621 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4622 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4623 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4624
4625 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4626 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02004627 9.2 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004628
4629 Arguments:
4630 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4631 named "server-state-file".
4632
4633 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4634 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4635 name is used as a file name.
4636
4637 none don't load any stat for this backend
4638
4639 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01004640 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
4641 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
4642 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
4643 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (eg: /etc/hosts)
4644 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004645
4646 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4647 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4648
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004649 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004650
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004651 global
4652 stats socket /tmp/socket
4653 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004654
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004655 defaults
4656 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004657
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004658 backend bk
4659 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4660 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004661
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004662
4663 Then one can run :
4664
4665 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4666
4667 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4668
4669 1
4670 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4671 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4672 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4673
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004674 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004675
4676 global
4677 stats socket /tmp/socket
4678 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4679
4680 defaults
4681 load-server-state-from-file local
4682
4683 backend bk
4684 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4685 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4686
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004687
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004688 Then one can run :
4689
4690 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4691
4692 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4693
4694 1
4695 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4696 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4697 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4698
4699 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4700 "show servers state"
4701
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004702
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004703log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004704log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004705no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004706 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4708 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004709
4710 Prefix :
4711 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4712 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4713 prefix does not allow arguments.
4714
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004715 Arguments :
4716 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4717 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4718 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4719 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4720 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4721 parameter.
4722
4723 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4724 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4725
4726 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4727 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4728 standard syslog port).
4729
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004730 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4731 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4732 standard syslog port).
4733
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004734 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4735 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4736 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4737 appropriately writeable).
4738
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004739 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4740 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004741
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004742 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4743 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4744 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4745 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4746 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4747 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4748 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4749 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4750 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4751 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4752 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4753
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004754 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4755
4756 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4757 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4758 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4759
4760 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4761 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4762 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004763 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4764 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4765 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4766 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4767 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004768
4769 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4770
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004771 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4772 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4773 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004774
4775 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4776 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4777 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4778 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4779
4780 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4781 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004782
4783 Example :
4784 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004785 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4786 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004787 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004788
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004789
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004790log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004791 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4792 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4793 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004794
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004795 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4796 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4797 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4798 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4799 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004800
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02004801 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
4802 "option httplog" directives.
4803
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004804log-format-sd <string>
4805 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4806 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4807 yes | yes | yes | no
4808
4809 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4810 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4811 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4812 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4813 which covers the log format string in depth.
4814
4815 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4816 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4817
4818 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4819 log format to "rfc5424".
4820
4821 Example :
4822 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4823
4824
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004825log-tag <string>
4826 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4827 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4828 yes | yes | yes | yes
4829
4830 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4831 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4832 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4833 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4834 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4835 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4836 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4837 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4838 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004839
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004840max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4841 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4842 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4843 yes | no | yes | yes
4844
4845 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4846 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4847 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4848 servers.
4849
4850 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4851 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4852 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4853 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4854 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4855 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4856 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4857 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4858 picking a different server.
4859
4860 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4861 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4862 even if they have to be queued.
4863
4864 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4865 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4866
4867
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004868maxconn <conns>
4869 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4871 yes | yes | yes | no
4872 Arguments :
4873 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4874 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4875 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4876 closes.
4877
4878 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4879 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4880 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4881 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01004882 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
4883 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
4884 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
4885 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004886
4887 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4888 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4889 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4890
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004891 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4892
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004893 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4894
4895
4896mode { tcp|http|health }
4897 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4899 yes | yes | yes | yes
4900 Arguments :
4901 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4902 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4903 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4904 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4905
4906 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4907 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4908 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4909 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4910 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4911
4912 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004913 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4914 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4915 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4916 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4917 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4918 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4919 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004920
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004921 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4922 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4923 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004924
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004925 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004926 defaults http_instances
4927 mode http
4928
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004929 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004930
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004931
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004932monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004933 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4935 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004936 Arguments :
4937 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4938 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004939 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004940 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4941 backend and its backup.
4942
4943 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4944 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4945 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4946 servers in a list of backends.
4947
4948 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4949 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4950 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4951 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4952 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4953 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4954 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004955 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4956 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004957
4958 Example:
4959 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004960 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004961 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4962 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4963 monitor-uri /site_alive
4964 monitor fail if site_dead
4965
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004966 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004967
4968
4969monitor-net <source>
4970 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4972 yes | yes | yes | no
4973 Arguments :
4974 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4975 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4976 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4977 followed by a mask.
4978
4979 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4980 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004981 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004982 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4983
4984 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4985 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4986 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4987 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004988 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4989 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4990 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004991
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004992 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4993 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4994 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4995 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4996 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4997 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004998
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004999 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5000 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005001
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005002 Example :
5003 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5004 frontend www
5005 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5006
5007 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5008
5009
5010monitor-uri <uri>
5011 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5013 yes | yes | yes | no
5014 Arguments :
5015 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5016 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5017
5018 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5019 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5020 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5021 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5022 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5023 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5024 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5025 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5026
5027 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
5028 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5029 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5030 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5031 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5032 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
5033
5034 Example :
5035 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5036 frontend www
5037 mode http
5038 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5039
5040 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5041
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005042
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005043option abortonclose
5044no option abortonclose
5045 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5047 yes | no | yes | yes
5048 Arguments : none
5049
5050 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5051 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5052 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5053 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005054 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005055 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5056 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5057 encountered while delivering the response.
5058
5059 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5060 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5061 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5062 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5063 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5064 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005065 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005066 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005067 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005068 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5069 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5070 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5071
5072 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
5073 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
5074 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5075 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5076 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5077 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5078 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5079 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005080 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005081
5082 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5083 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5084
5085 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5086
5087
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005088option accept-invalid-http-request
5089no option accept-invalid-http-request
5090 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5092 yes | yes | yes | no
5093 Arguments : none
5094
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005095 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005096 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5097 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5098 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5099 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5100 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5101 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5102 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005103 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5104 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5105 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5106 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
5107 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005108 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005109 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5110 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5111 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005112
5113 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5114 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5115 been confirmed.
5116
5117 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5118 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005119 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5120 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005121 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5122
5123 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5124 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5125
5126 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5127 stats socket.
5128
5129
5130option accept-invalid-http-response
5131no option accept-invalid-http-response
5132 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5134 yes | no | yes | yes
5135 Arguments : none
5136
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005137 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005138 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5139 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5140 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5141 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5142 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5143 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5144 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005145 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5146 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5147 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005148
5149 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5150 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5151 been confirmed.
5152
5153 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5154 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5155 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5156 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5157
5158 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5159 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5160
5161 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5162 stats socket.
5163
5164
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005165option allbackups
5166no option allbackups
5167 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5169 yes | no | yes | yes
5170 Arguments : none
5171
5172 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5173 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5174 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5175 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5176 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5177 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5178 order between the backup servers anymore.
5179
5180 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5181 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5182
5183 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5184 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5185
5186
5187option checkcache
5188no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005189 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5191 yes | no | yes | yes
5192 Arguments : none
5193
5194 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5195 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005196 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005197 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5198 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005199 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005200
5201 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005202 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005203 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005204 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5205 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005206 to the client are :
5207 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005208 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005209 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005210 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
5211 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
5212 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5213 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5214 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5215 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5216 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5217 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5218 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5219 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5220 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5221
5222 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005223 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005224 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005225 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005226 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5227
5228 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5229 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005230 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005231 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
5232
5233 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5234 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5235
5236
5237option clitcpka
5238no option clitcpka
5239 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5241 yes | yes | yes | no
5242 Arguments : none
5243
5244 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5245 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5246 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5247 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5248
5249 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5250 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5251 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5252 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5253
5254 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5255 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5256 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5257 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5258 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5259
5260 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5261
5262 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5263 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5264 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5265
5266 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5267 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5268
5269 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5270
5271
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005272option contstats
5273 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5275 yes | yes | yes | no
5276 Arguments : none
5277
5278 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5279 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5280 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5281 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005282 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5283 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5284 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5285 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5286 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005287
5288
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005289option dontlog-normal
5290no option dontlog-normal
5291 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5293 yes | yes | yes | no
5294 Arguments : none
5295
5296 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5297 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5298 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5299 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5300 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5301 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5302 logged.
5303
5304 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5305 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5306 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5307
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005308 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005309 logging.
5310
5311
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005312option dontlognull
5313no option dontlognull
5314 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5315 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5316 yes | yes | yes | no
5317 Arguments : none
5318
5319 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5320 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5321 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5322 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5323 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5324 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005325 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5326 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5327 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005328
5329 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5330 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5331 would not be logged.
5332
5333 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5334 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5335
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005336 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5337 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005338
5339
5340option forceclose
5341no option forceclose
5342 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005344 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005345 Arguments : none
5346
5347 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5348 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5349 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5350 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5351 global session times in the logs.
5352
5353 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005354 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005355 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005356
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005357 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5358 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5359 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5360
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005361 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5362 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005363
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005364 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5365 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5366
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005367 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005368
5369
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005370option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005371 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5373 yes | yes | yes | yes
5374 Arguments :
5375 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5376 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005377 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005378 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005379
5380 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5381 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5382 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5383 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5384 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5385 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5386 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005387 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5388 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5389 possible that the client has already brought one.
5390
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005391 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005392 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005393 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5394 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005395 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5396 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005397
5398 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5399 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5400 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5401 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5402 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5403 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5404 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5405
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005406 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5407 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5408 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5409 are under the control of the end-user.
5410
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005411 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005412 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5413 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005414 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5415 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5416 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005417
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005418 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005419 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5420 frontend www
5421 mode http
5422 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5423
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005424 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5425 backend www
5426 mode http
5427 option forwardfor header X-Client
5428
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005429 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005430 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005431
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005432
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005433option http-buffer-request
5434no option http-buffer-request
5435 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5437 yes | yes | yes | yes
5438 Arguments : none
5439
5440 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5441 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5442 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5443 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5444 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5445 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5446 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5447 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005448 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005449 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5450 default.
5451
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005452 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005453
5454
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005455option http-ignore-probes
5456no option http-ignore-probes
5457 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5459 yes | yes | yes | no
5460 Arguments : none
5461
5462 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5463 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5464 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5465 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5466 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5467 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5468 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5469 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5470 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5471 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5472 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5473 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5474
5475 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5476 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5477 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5478 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5479 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5480 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5481 are often the only way to detect them.
5482
5483 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5484 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5485
5486 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5487
5488
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005489option http-keep-alive
5490no option http-keep-alive
5491 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5493 yes | yes | yes | yes
5494 Arguments : none
5495
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005496 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5497 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5498 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5499 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5500 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5501 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5502 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5503
5504 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5505 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005506 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5507 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5508 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5509 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5510 situations where this option may be useful :
5511
5512 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5513 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5514
5515 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5516 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5517
5518 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5519 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5520 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5521 request.
5522
5523 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5524 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005525 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5526 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5527 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005528
5529 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5530 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5531
5532 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5533 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5534 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5535 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5536 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5537 not set.
5538
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005539 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5540 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005541 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005542 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005543
5544 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005545 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5546 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005547
5548
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005549option http-no-delay
5550no option http-no-delay
5551 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5553 yes | yes | yes | yes
5554 Arguments : none
5555
5556 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5557 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5558 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5559 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5560 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5561 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5562 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5563 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5564 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5565 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5566 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5567 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5568 affected.
5569
5570 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5571 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5572 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5573 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5574 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5575 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5576 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5577 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5578 latency environments.
5579
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005580 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5581
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005582
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005583option http-pretend-keepalive
5584no option http-pretend-keepalive
5585 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5587 yes | yes | yes | yes
5588 Arguments : none
5589
5590 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5591 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5592 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5593 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5594 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5595 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5596 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5597 consider the response complete.
5598
5599 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5600 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5601 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5602 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5603 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5604 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5605
5606 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5607 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5608 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5609 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5610 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5611 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5612 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5613
5614 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5615 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005616 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005617 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5618 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005619
5620 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5621 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5622
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005623 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5624 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005625
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005626
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005627option http-server-close
5628no option http-server-close
5629 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5631 yes | yes | yes | yes
5632 Arguments : none
5633
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005634 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5635 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5636 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5637 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5638 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5639 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5640 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5641 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5642 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5643 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5644 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
5645 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
5646 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5647 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5648 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5649 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005650
5651 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5652 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5653 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5654 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005655 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5656 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005657
5658 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5659 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005660 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5661 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005662 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5663 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005664
5665 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5666 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5667
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005668 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005669 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5670 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005671
5672
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005673option http-tunnel
5674no option http-tunnel
5675 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5677 yes | yes | yes | yes
5678 Arguments : none
5679
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005680 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5681 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5682 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5683 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5684 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5685 "option http-tunnel".
5686
5687 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005688 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005689 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5690 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5691 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5692 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5693 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5694 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5695 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005696
5697 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5698 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5699
5700 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5701 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5702 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5703
5704
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005705option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005706no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005707 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5709 yes | yes | yes | no
5710 Arguments : none
5711
5712 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
5713 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5714 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5715 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5716 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5717 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5718 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5719
5720 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5721 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005722 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5723 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5724 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005725
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005726 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5727 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5728 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5729 front of an existing proxy.
5730
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005731 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5732
5733 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5734 http-server-close".
5735
5736
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005737option httpchk
5738option httpchk <uri>
5739option httpchk <method> <uri>
5740option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5741 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5743 yes | no | yes | yes
5744 Arguments :
5745 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5746 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5747 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5748 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5749 ones.
5750
5751 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5752 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5753 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5754
5755 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5756 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5757 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5758 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5759 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5760
5761 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5762 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5763 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5764 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5765 the lack of any response.
5766
5767 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5768
5769 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5770 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5771 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5772
5773 Examples :
5774 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5775 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5776 backend https_relay
5777 mode tcp
5778 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5779 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5780
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005781 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5782 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5783 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005784
5785
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005786option httpclose
5787no option httpclose
5788 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5790 yes | yes | yes | yes
5791 Arguments : none
5792
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005793 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5794 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5795 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5796 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005797 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005798 "option http-tunnel".
5799
5800 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5801 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5802 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5803 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5804 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5805 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5806 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5807 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005808
5809 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005810 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005811 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5812 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5813 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5814 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5815 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005816
5817 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5818 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005819 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5820 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005821 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5822 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005823
5824 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5825 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5826
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005827 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5828 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005829
5830
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005831option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005832 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5833 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5834 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005835 Arguments :
5836 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5837 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5838 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5839 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5840 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005841
5842 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5843 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5844 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5845 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5846 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5847 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5848 ports.
5849
5850 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5851
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005852 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5853 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005854
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005855 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
5856
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005857 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005858
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005859
5860option http_proxy
5861no option http_proxy
5862 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5864 yes | yes | yes | yes
5865 Arguments : none
5866
5867 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5868 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5869 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5870 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5871 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5872
5873 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5874 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005875 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
5876 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005877
5878 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5879 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5880
5881 Example :
5882 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5883 backend direct_forward
5884 option httpclose
5885 option http_proxy
5886
5887 See also : "option httpclose"
5888
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005889
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005890option independent-streams
5891no option independent-streams
5892 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5894 yes | yes | yes | yes
5895 Arguments : none
5896
5897 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5898 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5899 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5900 receive data or not.
5901
5902 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5903 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5904 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5905 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5906 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5907 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5908 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5909 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5910 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5911 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5912 socket buffers.
5913
5914 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5915 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5916 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5917 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5918 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5919
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005920 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005921 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5922 deprecated.
5923
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005924 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005925
5926
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005927option ldap-check
5928 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5929 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5930 yes | no | yes | yes
5931 Arguments : none
5932
5933 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5934 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5935 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5936 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5937
5938 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5939 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5940
5941 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5942 configure it.
5943
5944 Example :
5945 option ldap-check
5946
5947 See also : "option httpchk"
5948
5949
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005950option external-check
5951 Use external processes for server health checks
5952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5953 yes | no | yes | yes
5954
5955 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5956 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5957 command".
5958
5959 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5960
5961 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5962
5963
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005964option log-health-checks
5965no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005966 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5968 yes | no | yes | yes
5969 Arguments : none
5970
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005971 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5972 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5973 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005974
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005975 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5976 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5977 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5978 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5979 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5980
5981 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5982 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005983
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005984 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5985 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5986 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005987
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005988
5989option log-separate-errors
5990no option log-separate-errors
5991 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5993 yes | yes | yes | no
5994 Arguments : none
5995
5996 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5997 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5998 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5999 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6000 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6001 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6002 provides very important information.
6003
6004 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6005 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6006 error logs.
6007
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006008 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006009 logging.
6010
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006011
6012option logasap
6013no option logasap
6014 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6015 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6016 yes | yes | yes | no
6017 Arguments : none
6018
6019 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6020 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6021 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6022 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6023 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6024 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6025 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006026 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006027 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6028 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6029
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006030 Examples :
6031 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6032 mode http
6033 option httplog
6034 option logasap
6035 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6036
6037 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6038 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6039 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6040 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6041
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006042 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006043 logging.
6044
6045
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006046option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006047 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6049 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006050 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006051 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6052 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006053 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006054
6055 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6056 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
6057 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
6058 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6059 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6060 in the MySQL table, like this :
6061
6062 USE mysql;
6063 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6064 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6065
6066 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
6067 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
6068 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6069 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6070 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6071 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6072 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6073 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6074 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6075
6076 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6077 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006078
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006079 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006080
6081 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6082 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6083 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6084 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006085 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6086 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006087
6088 See also: "option httpchk"
6089
6090
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006091option nolinger
6092no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006093 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006094 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6095 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006096 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006097
6098 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
6099 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6100 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6101 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6102 connections.
6103
6104 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6105 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6106 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6107 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6108 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6109 this too.
6110
6111 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6112 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6113 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6114
6115 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6116 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6117 for servers.
6118
6119 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6120 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6121
6122
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006123option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6124 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6126 yes | yes | yes | yes
6127 Arguments :
6128 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6129 matching <network>
6130 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6131 header name.
6132
6133 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6134 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6135 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6136 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6137 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6138 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6139 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6140 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6141 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6142 possible that the client has already brought one.
6143
6144 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6145 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6146 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6147 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6148 header and requires different one.
6149
6150 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6151 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6152 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6153 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6154 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6155 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6156 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6157
6158 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6159 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6160 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6161 both are defined.
6162
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006163 Examples :
6164 # Original Destination address
6165 frontend www
6166 mode http
6167 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6168
6169 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6170 backend www
6171 mode http
6172 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6173
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006174 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6175 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006176
6177
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006178option persist
6179no option persist
6180 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6181 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6182 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006183 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006184
6185 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6186 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6187 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6188 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6189 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6190 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6191 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6192 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6193 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6194 redirected to another valid server.
6195
6196 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6197 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6198
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006199 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006200
6201
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006202option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6203 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6204 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6205 yes | no | yes | yes
6206 Arguments :
6207 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6208 PostgreSQL server.
6209
6210 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6211 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6212 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6213 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6214
6215 See also: "option httpchk"
6216
6217
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006218option prefer-last-server
6219no option prefer-last-server
6220 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6221 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6222 yes | no | yes | yes
6223 Arguments : none
6224
6225 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6226 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6227 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6228 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6229 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6230 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6231 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6232 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6233 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006234 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6235 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6236 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6237 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6238 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6239 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6240 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006241
6242 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6243 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6244
6245 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6246
6247
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006248option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006249option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006250no option redispatch
6251 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6252 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6253 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006254 Arguments :
6255 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6256 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6257 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
6258 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
6259 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
6260 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
6261 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6262 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6263 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6264
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006265
6266 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6267 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6268 be able to access the service anymore.
6269
6270 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6271 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6272
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006273 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006274 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6275 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006276
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006277 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6278 "redisp" keywords.
6279
6280 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6281 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6282
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006283 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006284
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006285
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006286option redis-check
6287 Use redis health checks for server testing
6288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6289 yes | no | yes | yes
6290 Arguments : none
6291
6292 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6293 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6294 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6295 find the "+PONG" response message.
6296
6297 Example :
6298 option redis-check
6299
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006300 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006301
6302
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006303option smtpchk
6304option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6305 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6306 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6307 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006308 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006309 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6310 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6311 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6312
6313 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6314 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6315 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6316
6317 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6318 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6319 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6320 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6321 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6322 dead server.
6323
6324 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6325 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6326 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6327 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6328
6329 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6330 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6331 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6332 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006333 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006334
6335 Example :
6336 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6337
6338 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6339
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006340
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006341option socket-stats
6342no option socket-stats
6343
6344 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6346 yes | yes | yes | no
6347
6348 Arguments : none
6349
6350
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006351option splice-auto
6352no option splice-auto
6353 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6355 yes | yes | yes | yes
6356 Arguments : none
6357
6358 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6359 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6360 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6361 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006362 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006363 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6364 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6365 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6366 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6367
6368 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6369 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6370 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6371 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6372 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6373 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6374 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6375 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6376 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6377 keyword.
6378
6379 Example :
6380 option splice-auto
6381
6382 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6383 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6384
6385 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6386 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6387
6388
6389option splice-request
6390no option splice-request
6391 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6393 yes | yes | yes | yes
6394 Arguments : none
6395
6396 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006397 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006398 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6399 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6400 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6401 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6402
6403 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6404
6405 Example :
6406 option splice-request
6407
6408 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6409 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6410
6411 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6412 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6413
6414
6415option splice-response
6416no option splice-response
6417 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6419 yes | yes | yes | yes
6420 Arguments : none
6421
6422 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006423 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006424 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6425 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6426 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6427 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6428
6429 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6430
6431 Example :
6432 option splice-response
6433
6434 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6435 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6436
6437 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6438 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6439
6440
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006441option spop-check
6442 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6444 no | no | no | yes
6445 Arguments : none
6446
6447 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6448 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6449 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6450 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6451
6452 Example :
6453 option spop-check
6454
6455 See also : "option httpchk"
6456
6457
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006458option srvtcpka
6459no option srvtcpka
6460 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6462 yes | no | yes | yes
6463 Arguments : none
6464
6465 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6466 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6467 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6468 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6469
6470 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6471 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6472 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6473 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6474
6475 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6476 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6477 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6478 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6479 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6480
6481 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6482
6483 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6484 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6485 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6486
6487 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6488 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6489
6490 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6491
6492
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006493option ssl-hello-chk
6494 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6496 yes | no | yes | yes
6497 Arguments : none
6498
6499 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6500 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6501 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6502 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6503 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6504 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6505 hello message.
6506
6507 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6508 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6509 messages, which is appreciable.
6510
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006511 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6512 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6513 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006514
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006515 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6516
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006517
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006518option tcp-check
6519 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6520 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6521 yes | no | yes | yes
6522
6523 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6524 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6525
6526 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6527 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6528 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6529
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006530 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006531 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6532 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6533 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6534 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6535 only.
6536
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006537 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006538 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6539 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6540 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6541 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6542
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006543 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006544 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6545 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006546 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006547 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6548 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6549 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6550 the respective protocols.
6551 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6552 analysed.
6553
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006554 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6555 script.
6556
6557 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6558 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6559 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6560 The "comment" is of course optional.
6561
6562
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006563 Examples :
6564 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6565 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006566 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006567
6568 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6569 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006570 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006571
6572 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6573 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006574 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006575 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006576 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006577 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006578 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006579 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006580 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6581 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006582 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006583 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6584 tcp-check expect string +OK
6585
6586 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6587 (send many headers before analyzing)
6588 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006589 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006590 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6591 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6592 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6593 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006594 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006595
6596
6597 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6598
6599
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006600option tcp-smart-accept
6601no option tcp-smart-accept
6602 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6604 yes | yes | yes | no
6605 Arguments : none
6606
6607 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6608 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6609 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6610 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6611 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6612 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6613
6614 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6615 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6616 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6617 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6618
6619 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6620 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6621 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6622 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6623
6624 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6625 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6626 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6627
6628 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6629 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6630 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6631
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006632 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6633
6634
6635option tcp-smart-connect
6636no option tcp-smart-connect
6637 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6639 yes | no | yes | yes
6640 Arguments : none
6641
6642 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6643 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6644 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6645 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6646 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6647
6648 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6649 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6650 complex.
6651
6652 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6653 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6654 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6655
6656 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6657 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6658
6659 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6660
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006661
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006662option tcpka
6663 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6665 yes | yes | yes | yes
6666 Arguments : none
6667
6668 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6669 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6670 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6671 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6672
6673 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6674 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6675 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6676 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6677
6678 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6679 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6680 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6681 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6682 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6683
6684 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6685
6686 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6687 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6688 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6689 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6690 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6691 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6692 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6693 backends.
6694
6695 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6696
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006697
6698option tcplog
6699 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6701 yes | yes | yes | yes
6702 Arguments : none
6703
6704 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6705 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6706 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6707 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6708 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6709 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6710 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6711 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6712
6713 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6714
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006715 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6716
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006717 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006718
6719
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006720option transparent
6721no option transparent
6722 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006724 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006725 Arguments : none
6726
6727 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6728 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6729 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6730 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6731 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6732 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6733 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6734 appropriate server.
6735
6736 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6737 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6738
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006739 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006740 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006741
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006742
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006743external-check command <command>
6744 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6746 yes | no | yes | yes
6747
6748 Arguments :
6749 <command> is the external command to run
6750
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006751 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6752
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006753 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006754
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006755 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6756 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6757 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6758 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6759 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6760 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006761
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006762 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6763
6764 Environment variables :
6765 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6766 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6767
6768 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6769
6770 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6771
6772 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6773 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6774 for a UNIX socket).
6775
6776 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6777
6778 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6779
6780 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6781
6782 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6783
6784 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6785
6786 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6787 socket).
6788
6789 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6790 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6791
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006792 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6793 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6794 failed.
6795
6796 Example :
6797 external-check command /bin/true
6798
6799 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6800
6801
6802external-check path <path>
6803 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6805 yes | no | yes | yes
6806
6807 Arguments :
6808 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6809
6810 The default path is "".
6811
6812 Example :
6813 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6814
6815 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6816 "external-check command"
6817
6818
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006819persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006820persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006821 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6823 yes | no | yes | yes
6824 Arguments :
6825 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006826 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6827 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006828
6829 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6830 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6831 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6832 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6833 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6834 forwarded to this server.
6835
6836 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6837 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6838 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006839 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006840 a single "listen" section.
6841
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006842 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6843 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6844 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6845
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006846 Example :
6847 listen tse-farm
6848 bind :3389
6849 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6850 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6851 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6852 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6853 persist rdp-cookie
6854 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006855 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006856 balance rdp-cookie
6857 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6858 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6859
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006860 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6861 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006862
6863
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006864rate-limit sessions <rate>
6865 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6867 yes | yes | yes | no
6868 Arguments :
6869 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6870 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6871
6872 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6873 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6874 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6875 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6876 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6877 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6878
6879 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6880 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6881 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6882 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6883
6884 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6885 listen smtp
6886 mode tcp
6887 bind :25
6888 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02006889 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006890
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006891 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6892 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6893 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006894
6895 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6896
6897
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006898redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6899redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6900redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006901 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6903 no | yes | yes | yes
6904
6905 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006906 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006907
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006908 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006909 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006910 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6911 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6912 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006913
6914 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6915 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6916 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6917 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6918 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006919 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6920 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6921 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6922 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006923
6924 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6925 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6926 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6927 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6928 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6929 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006930 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006931 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006932 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6933 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6934 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006935
6936 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006937 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6938 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6939 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02006940 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006941 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6942 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6943 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6944 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006945
6946 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6947 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6948
6949 - "drop-query"
6950 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6951 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6952 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6953 with a location-type redirect.
6954
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006955 - "append-slash"
6956 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6957 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6958 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6959 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6960
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006961 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6962 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6963 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6964 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6965 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6966 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6967 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6968
6969 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6970 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6971 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6972 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6973 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6974 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6975 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006976
6977 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6978 acl clear dst_port 80
6979 acl secure dst_port 8080
6980 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006981 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006982 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006983 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6984
6985 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006986 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6987 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6988 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006989 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006990
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006991 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6992 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6993 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6994
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006995 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006996 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006997
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006998 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02006999 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7000 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7001 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007002
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007003 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007004
7005
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007006redisp (deprecated)
7007redispatch (deprecated)
7008 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7009 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7010 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007011 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007012
7013 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7014 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7015 be able to access the service anymore.
7016
7017 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7018 redistribute them to a working server.
7019
7020 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7021 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7022 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007023
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007024 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7025 "option redispatch" instead.
7026
7027 See also : "option redispatch"
7028
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007029
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007030reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007031 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7033 no | yes | yes | yes
7034 Arguments :
7035 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7036 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007037 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007038
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007039 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7040 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7041
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007042 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7043 the last header of an HTTP request.
7044
7045 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7046 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7047 responses.
7048
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007049 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7050 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7051 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7052
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007053 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7054 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007055
7056
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007057reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7058reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007059 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7061 no | yes | yes | yes
7062 Arguments :
7063 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7064 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7065 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7066 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7067 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7068 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7069 ignores case.
7070
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007071 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7072 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7073
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007074 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7075 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7076 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7077 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007078 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007079
7080 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7081 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7082
7083 Example :
7084 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7085 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7086 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7087
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007088 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7089 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007090
7091
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007092reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7093reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007094 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7096 no | yes | yes | yes
7097 Arguments :
7098 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7099 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7100 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7101 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7102 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7103 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7104
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007105 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7106 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7107
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007108 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7109 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7110 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7111 next servers.
7112
7113 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7114 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7115 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7116
7117 Example :
7118 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7119 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7120 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7121
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007122 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7123 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007124
7125
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007126reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7127reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007128 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7130 no | yes | yes | yes
7131 Arguments :
7132 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7133 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7134 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7135 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7136 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7137 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7138 case.
7139
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007140 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7141 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7142
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007143 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7144 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7145 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7146 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007147 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007148
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007149 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007150 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007151 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007152
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007153 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7154 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7155
7156 Example :
7157 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7158 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7159 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7160
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007161 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7162 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007163
7164
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007165reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7166reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007167 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7169 no | yes | yes | yes
7170 Arguments :
7171 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7172 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7173 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7174 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7175 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7176 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7177 case.
7178
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007179 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7180 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7181
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007182 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7183 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7184 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7185 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7186
7187 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7188 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7189
7190 Example :
7191 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7192 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7193 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7194 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7195
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007196 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7197 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007198
7199
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007200reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7201reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007202 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7204 no | yes | yes | yes
7205 Arguments :
7206 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7207 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7208 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7209 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7210 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7211 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7212
7213 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7214 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7215 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7216 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007217 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007218
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007219 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7220 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7221
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007222 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7223 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7224 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7225
7226 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7227 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7228 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7229 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7230 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7231
7232 Example :
7233 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007234 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007235 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7236 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7237
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007238 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7239 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007240
7241
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007242reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7243reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007244 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7245 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7246 no | yes | yes | yes
7247 Arguments :
7248 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7249 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7250 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7251 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7252 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7253 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7254 ignores case.
7255
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007256 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7257 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7258
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007259 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7260 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007261 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7262 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7263 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007264 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7265 not set.
7266
7267 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7268 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7269 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7270 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7271 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7272
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007273 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007274 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
7275 # block all others.
7276 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7277 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7278
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007279 # block bad guys
7280 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7281 reqitarpit . if badguys
7282
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007283 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7284 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007285
7286
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007287retries <value>
7288 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7289 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7290 yes | no | yes | yes
7291 Arguments :
7292 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7293 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7294 default value is 3.
7295
7296 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7297 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7298 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7299
7300 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007301 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7302 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007303
7304 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7305 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7306
7307 See also : "option redispatch"
7308
7309
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007310rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007311 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7313 no | yes | yes | yes
7314 Arguments :
7315 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7316 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007317 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007318
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007319 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7320 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7321
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007322 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7323 the last header of an HTTP response.
7324
7325 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7326 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7327 responses.
7328
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007329 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7330 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007331
7332
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007333rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7334rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007335 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7337 no | yes | yes | yes
7338 Arguments :
7339 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7340 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7341 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7342 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7343 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7344 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7345 ignores case.
7346
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007347 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7348 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7349
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007350 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7351 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007352 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007353 client.
7354
7355 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7356 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7357 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7358
7359 Example :
7360 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007361 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007362
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007363 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7364 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007365
7366
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007367rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7368rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007369 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7371 no | yes | yes | yes
7372 Arguments :
7373 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7374 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7375 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7376 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7377 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7378 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7379 ignores case.
7380
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007381 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7382 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7383
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007384 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7385 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7386 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7387 case-sensitive.
7388
7389 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007390 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7391 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7392 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007393
7394 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7395 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7396
7397 Example :
7398 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7399 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7400
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007401 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7402 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007403
7404
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007405rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7406rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007407 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7409 no | yes | yes | yes
7410 Arguments :
7411 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7412 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7413 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7414 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7415 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7416 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7417 ignores case.
7418
7419 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7420 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7421 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7422 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007423 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007424
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007425 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7426 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7427
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007428 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7429 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7430 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7431
7432 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7433 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7434 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7435 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7436 are not case-sensitive.
7437
7438 Example :
7439 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7440 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7441
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007442 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7443 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007444
7445
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007446server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007447 Declare a server in a backend
7448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7449 no | no | yes | yes
7450 Arguments :
7451 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007452 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007453 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007454
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007455 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7456 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7457 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7458 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007459 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7460 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7461 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7462 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7463 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007464 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7465 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7466 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7467 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7468 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7469 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7470 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007471 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007472 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7473 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007474 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7475 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007476
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007477 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007478 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7479 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7480 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7481 adding this value to the client's port.
7482
7483 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7484 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007485 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007486
7487 Examples :
7488 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7489 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007490 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007491 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7492 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7493 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007494
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007495 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7496 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7497 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7498 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7499 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7500
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007501 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7502 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007503
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007504server-state-file-name [<file>]
7505 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7506 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7507 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7508 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7509 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7510 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7511
7512 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7513 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7514
7515 global
7516 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7517
7518 backend bk
7519 load-server-state-from-file
7520
7521 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7522 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007523
7524source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007525source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007526source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007527 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7529 yes | no | yes | yes
7530 Arguments :
7531 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7532 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007533
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007534 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007535 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7536 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7537 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7538 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7539 supported prefixes are :
7540 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7541 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7542 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007543 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007544 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7545 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007546
7547 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7548 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007549 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7550 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7551 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007552
7553 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7554 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7555 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7556 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7557 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7558 <addr>.
7559
7560 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7561 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7562 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7563 port.
7564
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007565 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7566 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7567 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7568 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007569 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007570 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7571 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7572 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7573 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7574 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7575 HTTP header.
7576
7577 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7578 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007579 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007580 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7581 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7582 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7583 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7584 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7585 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7586 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7587
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007588 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7589 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7590 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7591 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7592 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7593 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7594
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007595 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7596 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7597 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7598 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7599
7600 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7601 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7602 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7603 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7604 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7605 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7606
7607 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7608 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7609 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7610 there are two methods :
7611
7612 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7613 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7614 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7615 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7616 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7617 of the client ranges may be used.
7618
7619 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7620 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7621 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7622 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7623 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7624 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7625 same session.
7626
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007627 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7628 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7629 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007630 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007631
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007632 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7633
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007634 Examples :
7635 backend private
7636 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7637 source 192.168.1.200
7638
7639 backend transparent_ssl1
7640 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7641 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7642
7643 backend transparent_ssl2
7644 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7645 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7646 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7647
7648 backend transparent_ssl3
7649 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7650 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7651 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7652
7653 backend transparent_smtp
7654 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7655 # with Tproxy version 4.
7656 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7657
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007658 backend transparent_http
7659 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7660 # proxy.
7661 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7662
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007663 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007664 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7665
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007666
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007667srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7668 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7670 yes | no | yes | yes
7671 Arguments :
7672 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7673 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7674 as explained at the top of this document.
7675
7676 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7677 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7678 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7679 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7680 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7681 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7682 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7683
7684 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7685 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7686 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7687 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7688 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007689 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007690 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007691 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007692
7693 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7694 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7695 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7696 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7697 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7698 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7699
7700 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7701 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7702
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007703 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7704 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007705
7706
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007707stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7708 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007710 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007711
7712 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7713 matched.
7714
7715 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7716 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7717
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007718 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7719 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7720 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7721
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007722 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7723 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7724 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7725 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007726
7727 Example :
7728 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7729 backend stats_localhost
7730 stats enable
7731 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7732
7733 Example :
7734 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7735 backend stats_auth
7736 stats enable
7737 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7738 stats admin if TRUE
7739
7740 Example :
7741 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7742 userlist stats-auth
7743 group admin users admin
7744 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7745 group readonly users haproxy
7746 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7747
7748 backend stats_auth
7749 stats enable
7750 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7751 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7752 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7753 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7754
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007755 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7756 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7757 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007758
7759
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007760stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7761 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007763 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007764 Arguments :
7765 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7766
7767 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7768
7769 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7770 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7771 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7772 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7773 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7774 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7775
7776 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7777 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7778 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007779 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007780
7781 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7782 report using "stats scope".
7783
7784 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7785 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7786 unobvious parameters.
7787
7788 Example :
7789 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7790 backend public_www
7791 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7792 stats enable
7793 stats hide-version
7794 stats scope .
7795 stats uri /admin?stats
7796 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7797 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7798 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7799
7800 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7801 backend private_monitoring
7802 stats enable
7803 stats uri /admin?stats
7804 stats refresh 5s
7805
7806 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7807
7808
7809stats enable
7810 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007812 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007813 Arguments : none
7814
7815 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7816 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7817 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7818 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7819 - stats auth : no authentication
7820 - stats scope : no restriction
7821
7822 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7823 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7824 unobvious parameters.
7825
7826 Example :
7827 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7828 backend public_www
7829 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7830 stats enable
7831 stats hide-version
7832 stats scope .
7833 stats uri /admin?stats
7834 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7835 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7836 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7837
7838 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7839 backend private_monitoring
7840 stats enable
7841 stats uri /admin?stats
7842 stats refresh 5s
7843
7844 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7845
7846
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007847stats hide-version
7848 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007850 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007851 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007852
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007853 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7854 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7855 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7856 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7857 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7858 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007859
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007860 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7861 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7862 unobvious parameters.
7863
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007864 Example :
7865 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7866 backend public_www
7867 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007868 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007869 stats hide-version
7870 stats scope .
7871 stats uri /admin?stats
7872 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7873 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7874 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007875
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007876 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7877 backend private_monitoring
7878 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007879 stats uri /admin?stats
7880 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007881
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007882 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007883
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007884
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007885stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7886 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7887 Access control for statistics
7888
7889 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7890 no | no | yes | yes
7891
7892 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7893 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7894 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7895 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7896 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7897 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7898
7899 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7900 instance.
7901
7902 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7903 about ACL usage.
7904
7905
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007906stats realm <realm>
7907 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007909 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007910 Arguments :
7911 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7912 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7913 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7914
7915 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7916 using a backslash ('\').
7917
7918 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7919 only related to authentication.
7920
7921 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7922 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7923 unobvious parameters.
7924
7925 Example :
7926 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7927 backend public_www
7928 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7929 stats enable
7930 stats hide-version
7931 stats scope .
7932 stats uri /admin?stats
7933 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7934 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7935 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7936
7937 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7938 backend private_monitoring
7939 stats enable
7940 stats uri /admin?stats
7941 stats refresh 5s
7942
7943 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7944
7945
7946stats refresh <delay>
7947 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007949 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007950 Arguments :
7951 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7952 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7953 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7954 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7955 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7956 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7957
7958 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7959 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7960 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7961 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7962
7963 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7964 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7965 unobvious parameters.
7966
7967 Example :
7968 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7969 backend public_www
7970 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7971 stats enable
7972 stats hide-version
7973 stats scope .
7974 stats uri /admin?stats
7975 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7976 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7977 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7978
7979 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7980 backend private_monitoring
7981 stats enable
7982 stats uri /admin?stats
7983 stats refresh 5s
7984
7985 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7986
7987
7988stats scope { <name> | "." }
7989 Enable statistics and limit access scope
7990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007991 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007992 Arguments :
7993 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
7994 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
7995 section in which the statement appears.
7996
7997 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
7998 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
7999 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8000 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8001 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8002 exists.
8003
8004 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8005 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8006 unobvious parameters.
8007
8008 Example :
8009 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8010 backend public_www
8011 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8012 stats enable
8013 stats hide-version
8014 stats scope .
8015 stats uri /admin?stats
8016 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8017 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8018 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8019
8020 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8021 backend private_monitoring
8022 stats enable
8023 stats uri /admin?stats
8024 stats refresh 5s
8025
8026 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8027
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008028
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008029stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008030 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008032 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008033
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008034 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008035 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8036
8037 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8038 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8039
8040 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8041 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008042 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008043
8044 Example :
8045 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8046 backend private_monitoring
8047 stats enable
8048 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8049 stats uri /admin?stats
8050 stats refresh 5s
8051
8052 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8053 global section.
8054
8055
8056stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008057 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8059 yes | yes | yes | yes
8060 Arguments : none
8061
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008062 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008063 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8064 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8065 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8066 - IP (socket, server)
8067 - cookie (backend, server)
8068
8069 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8070 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008071 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008072
8073 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8074
8075
8076stats show-node [ <name> ]
8077 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008079 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008080 Arguments:
8081 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8082 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8083
8084 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8085 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008086 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008087
8088 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8089 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8090 unobvious parameters.
8091
8092 Example:
8093 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8094 backend private_monitoring
8095 stats enable
8096 stats show-node Europe-1
8097 stats uri /admin?stats
8098 stats refresh 5s
8099
8100 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8101 section.
8102
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008103
8104stats uri <prefix>
8105 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008107 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008108 Arguments :
8109 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8110 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8111 query string.
8112
8113 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8114 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8115 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8116 possible to reach it in the application.
8117
8118 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008119 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008120 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8121 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8122 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8123 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8124
8125 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8126 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8127 an address or a port to statistics only.
8128
8129 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8130 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8131 unobvious parameters.
8132
8133 Example :
8134 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8135 backend public_www
8136 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8137 stats enable
8138 stats hide-version
8139 stats scope .
8140 stats uri /admin?stats
8141 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8142 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8143 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8144
8145 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8146 backend private_monitoring
8147 stats enable
8148 stats uri /admin?stats
8149 stats refresh 5s
8150
8151 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8152
8153
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008154stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8155 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008157 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008158
8159 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008160 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008161 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8162 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
8163 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8164
8165 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8166 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8167 the "stick-table" statement.
8168
8169 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8170 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8171 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8172 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8173 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8174
8175 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8176 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8177 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8178 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8179 transformation rules.
8180
8181 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8182 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8183 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8184 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8185 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8186 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8187 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8188
8189 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8190 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8191 ACL based conditions.
8192
8193 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8194 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8195 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8196 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8197
8198 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8199 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8200 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8201 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8202
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008203 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8204 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8205 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8206
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008207 Example :
8208 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8209 # last 30 minutes
8210 backend pop
8211 mode tcp
8212 balance roundrobin
8213 stick store-request src
8214 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8215 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8216 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8217
8218 backend smtp
8219 mode tcp
8220 balance roundrobin
8221 stick match src table pop
8222 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8223 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8224
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008225 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008226 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008227
8228
8229stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8230 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8232 no | no | yes | yes
8233
8234 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8235 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8236 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8237 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8238
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008239 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8240 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8241 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8242
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008243 Examples :
8244 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008245 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008246
8247 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8248 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8249 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8250
8251
8252 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8253 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8254 backend http
8255 mode http
8256 balance roundrobin
8257 stick on src table https
8258 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8259 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8260 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8261
8262 backend https
8263 mode tcp
8264 balance roundrobin
8265 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8266 stick on src
8267 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8268 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8269
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008270 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008271
8272
8273stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8274 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8276 no | no | yes | yes
8277
8278 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008279 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008280 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8281 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8282 server is selected.
8283
8284 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8285 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8286 the "stick-table" statement.
8287
8288 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8289 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8290 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8291 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8292 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8293 address.
8294
8295 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8296 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8297 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8298 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8299 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8300 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8301 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8302 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8303 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8304 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8305
8306 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8307 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8308 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8309 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8310 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8311 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8312 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8313
8314 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8315 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8316 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8317 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8318
8319 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8320 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8321 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8322 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8323 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8324 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008325 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8326 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8327 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8328 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8329 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8330 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008331
8332 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8333 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8334 the request.
8335
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008336 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8337 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8338 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8339
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008340 Example :
8341 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8342 # last 30 minutes
8343 backend pop
8344 mode tcp
8345 balance roundrobin
8346 stick store-request src
8347 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8348 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8349 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8350
8351 backend smtp
8352 mode tcp
8353 balance roundrobin
8354 stick match src table pop
8355 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8356 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8357
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008358 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008359 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008360
8361
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008362stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008363 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8364 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008365 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008367 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008368
8369 Arguments :
8370 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8371 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8372 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8373 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8374
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008375 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8376 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8377 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8378 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8379
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008380 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8381 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8382 instance.
8383
8384 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8385 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8386 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8387 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8388 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8389 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008390 to 32 characters.
8391
8392 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8393 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8394 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008395 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008396 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8397 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008398
8399 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008400 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8401 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008402 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8403 increase.
8404
8405 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008406 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8407 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8408 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008409
8410 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8411 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8412 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8413 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8414 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8415 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8416 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8417 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8418 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8419 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8420 parameter (see below).
8421
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008422 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8423 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8424 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8425 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8426 soft restart.
8427
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008428 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8429 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008430
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008431 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8432 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8433 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8434 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
8435 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008436 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008437 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8438 if not expiration delay is specified.
8439
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008440 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8441 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8442 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8443 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008444 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8445 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8446 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8447 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8448 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8449 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8450 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8451 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8452 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8453 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8454 types and their arguments.
8455
8456 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8457 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8458 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8459 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8460
8461 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8462 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8463 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8464 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8465
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008466 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8467 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8468 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8469 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8470 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8471 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8472
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008473 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8474 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8475 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8476 they were received.
8477
8478 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8479 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8480 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8481 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8482 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8483
8484 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8485 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8486 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8487 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8488 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8489
8490 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8491 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8492 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8493
8494 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8495 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8496 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8497 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8498 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8499
8500 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8501 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8502 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8503 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8504 the client side.
8505
8506 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8507 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8508 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8509 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8510 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8511 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8512 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8513
8514 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8515 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8516 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8517 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8518 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8519 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8520 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8521
8522 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8523 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8524 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8525 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8526 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8527 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8528
8529 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8530 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8531 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8532 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8533
8534 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8535 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8536 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8537 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8538 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8539 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8540 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8541 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8542 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8543 recommended for better fairness.
8544
8545 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8546 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8547 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8548 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8549
8550 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8551 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8552 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8553 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8554 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8555 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8556 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8557 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8558 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8559 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008560
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008561 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8562 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008563 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8564 reference it.
8565
8566 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8567 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008568 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8569 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8570 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008571
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008572 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8573 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8574 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8575 something that can be ignored.
8576
8577 Example:
8578 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8579 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8580 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8581 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8582
8583 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008584 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008585
8586
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008587stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008588 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8590 no | no | yes | yes
8591
8592 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008593 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008594 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8595 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8596 server is selected.
8597
8598 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8599 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8600 the "stick-table" statement.
8601
8602 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8603 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8604 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8605 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8606
8607 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8608 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8609 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8610 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8611 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8612 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008613 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008614 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8615 rules.
8616
8617 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8618 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8619 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8620 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8621 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8622 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8623 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8624
8625 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8626 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8627 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8628 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8629
8630 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8631 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8632 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8633 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8634 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8635 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008636 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8637 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8638 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8639 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8640 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8641 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8642 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8643 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8644 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008645
8646 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8647
8648 Example :
8649 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8650 backend https
8651 mode tcp
8652 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008653 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008654 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008655
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008656 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8657 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8658
8659 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8660 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8661 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8662
8663 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8664 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008665
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008666 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8667 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8668 # at offset 44.
8669
8670 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8671 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8672
8673 # Learn on response if server hello.
8674 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008675
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008676 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8677 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8678
8679 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8680 extraction.
8681
8682
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008683tcp-check connect [params*]
8684 Opens a new connection
8685 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8686 no | no | yes | yes
8687
8688 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8689 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8690 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8691
8692 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8693 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8694 of the sequence.
8695
8696 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8697 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8698 do.
8699
8700 Parameters :
8701 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8702 use the TCP connection.
8703
8704 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8705 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8706 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8707
8708 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8709
8710 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8711
8712 Examples:
8713 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8714 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8715 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8716 option tcp-check
8717 tcp-check connect
8718 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8719 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8720 tcp-check send \r\n
8721 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8722 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8723 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8724 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8725 tcp-check send \r\n
8726 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8727 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8728
8729 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8730 option tcp-check
8731 tcp-check connect port 110
8732 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8733 tcp-check connect port 143
8734 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8735 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8736
8737 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8738
8739
8740tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8741 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8742 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8743 no | no | yes | yes
8744
8745 Arguments :
8746 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8747 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8748 binary.
8749 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8750 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8751 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8752
8753 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8754 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8755 with the usual backslash ('\').
8756 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8757 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8758 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8759 used upper or lower case.
8760
8761
8762 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8763
8764 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8765 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8766 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8767 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8768 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8769 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8770 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8771 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8772
8773 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8774 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8775 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8776 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8777 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8778 expression.
8779
8780 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8781 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8782 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8783 this exact hexadecimal string.
8784 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8785
8786 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8787 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8788 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8789 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8790 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8791 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8792 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8793 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8794 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8795 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8796 the null character.
8797
8798 Examples :
8799 # perform a POP check
8800 option tcp-check
8801 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8802
8803 # perform an IMAP check
8804 option tcp-check
8805 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8806
8807 # look for the redis master server
8808 option tcp-check
8809 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008810 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008811 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8812 tcp-check expect string role:master
8813 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8814 tcp-check expect string +OK
8815
8816
8817 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8818 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8819
8820
8821tcp-check send <data>
8822 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8823 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8824 no | no | yes | yes
8825
8826 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8827 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8828
8829 Examples :
8830 # look for the redis master server
8831 option tcp-check
8832 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8833 tcp-check expect string role:master
8834
8835 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8836 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8837
8838
8839tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8840 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8841 tcp health check
8842 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8843 no | no | yes | yes
8844
8845 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8846 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8847 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8848 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8849 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8850 hexadecimal string.
8851 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8852
8853 Examples :
8854 # redis check in binary
8855 option tcp-check
8856 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8857 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8858
8859
8860 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8861 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8862
8863
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008864tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8865 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8867 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008868 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008869 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8870 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008871
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008872 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008873
8874 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8875 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008876 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8877 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8878 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8879 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8880 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8881 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008882
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008883 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8884 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8885 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8886 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008887
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008888 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008889 - accept :
8890 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8891 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8892 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008893
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008894 - reject :
8895 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8896 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8897 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8898 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8899 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8900 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8901 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8902 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8903 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8904 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8905 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02008906 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008907
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008908 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8909 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8910 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8911 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8912 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8913 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8914 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8915 hosts.
8916
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01008917 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
8918 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
8919 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
8920 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
8921 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
8922 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
8923 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
8924 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
8925
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008926 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8927 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8928 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8929 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8930 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8931 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8932 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8933 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8934 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008935 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8936 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008937
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008938 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008939 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008940 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008941 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008942 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8943 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008944 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008945 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8946 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8947 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8948 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8949 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008950
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008951 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008952 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008953 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008954 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8955 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8956 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8957 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008958
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008959 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8960 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8961 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8962 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008963
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008964 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
8965 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
8966 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
8967 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
8968 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008969 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
8970 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
8971 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
8972 layer7 information is extracted.
8973
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008974 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
8975 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
8976 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
8977 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
8978 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008979
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008980 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
8981 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
8982 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
8983 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
8984
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008985 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
8986 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
8987 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
8988 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
8989 continues.
8990
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02008991 - set-src <expr> :
8992 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
8993 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
8994 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
8995 set-src"
8996
8997 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8998 followed by some converters.
8999
9000 Example:
9001
9002 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9003
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009004 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9005 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009006
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009007 - set-src-port <expr> :
9008 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9009 expression.
9010
9011 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9012 followed by some converters.
9013
9014 Example:
9015
9016 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9017
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009018 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9019 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9020 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009021
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009022 - set-dst <expr> :
9023 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9024 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9025 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9026 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9027 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9028
9029 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9030 followed by some converters.
9031
9032 Example:
9033
9034 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9035 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9036
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009037 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9038 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9039
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009040 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9041 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9042 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9043 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9044
9045
9046 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9047 followed by some converters.
9048
9049 Example:
9050
9051 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9052
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009053 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9054 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9055 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9056
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009057 - "silent-drop" :
9058 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9059 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9060 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9061 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9062 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9063 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9064 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9065 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9066 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9067 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9068 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9069 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9070 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9071 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9072 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9073 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9074
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009075 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9076 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9077 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009078
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009079 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9080 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9081 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009082
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009083 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009084 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009085 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009086
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009087 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9088 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9089 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009090
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009091 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009092 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9093 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009094
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009095 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9096
9097 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9098
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009099 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9100
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009101 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009102
9103
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009104tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9105 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009107 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009108 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009109 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9110 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009111
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009112 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009113
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009114 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
9115 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9116 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9117 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9118 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009119
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009120 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9121 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9122 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9123 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009124 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9125 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9126 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9127 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9128 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9129 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009130 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009131 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009132
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009133 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9134 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9135 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9136 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009137
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009138 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009139 - accept : the request is accepted
9140 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9141 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009142 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009143 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009144 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009145 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009146 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009147 - silent-drop
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009148
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009149 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9150 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009151
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009152 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9153 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9154 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9155 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9156 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9157 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009158
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009159 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009160 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9161 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009162
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009163 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009164 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9165 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9166 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9167 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009168 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9169 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9170 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009171
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009172 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009173 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9174 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9175 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009176
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009177 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009178 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9179 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009180
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009181 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9182 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009183 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009184 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9185 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009186 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009187 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009188 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009189 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9190 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009191 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009192 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9193 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009194
9195 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9196 followed by some converters.
9197
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009198 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9199 <var-name>.
9200
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009201 Example:
9202
9203 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009204 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009205
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009206 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009207 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9208 # and reject everything else.
9209 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9210 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009211 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009212 tcp-request content reject
9213
9214 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009215 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9216 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9217 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009218 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009219
9220 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9221 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9222 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009223 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009224 tcp-request content reject
9225
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009226 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009227 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009228 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009229 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009230 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9231 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009232
9233 Example:
9234 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9235 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009236 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009237
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009238 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009239 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009240
9241 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009242 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009243 # protecting all our sites
9244 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009245 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9246 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009247 ...
9248 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9249
9250 backend http_dynamic
9251 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009252 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009253 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009254 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009255 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009256 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009257 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009258
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009259 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009260
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009261 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session", and
9262 "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009263
9264
9265tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9266 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009268 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009269 Arguments :
9270 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9271 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9272 as explained at the top of this document.
9273
9274 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9275 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9276 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9277 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9278 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9279
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009280 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9281 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9282 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9283 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9284
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009285 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9286 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009287 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009288 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009289 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9290 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9291 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9292 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009293
9294 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9295 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9296 it pass through unaffected.
9297
9298 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9299 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9300 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009301 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009302 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9303 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009304 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9305 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9306 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009307
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009308 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009309 "timeout client".
9310
9311
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009312tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9313 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9315 no | no | yes | yes
9316 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009317 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9318 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009319
9320 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9321
9322 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
9323 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9324 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009325 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9326 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009327
9328 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9329
9330 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9331 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9332 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9333 inserted.
9334
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009335 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009336 - accept :
9337 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9338 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9339 the rules evaluation.
9340
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009341 - close :
9342 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9343 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9344 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9345 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9346 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9347 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009348 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009349 protocols.
9350
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009351 - reject :
9352 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9353 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009354 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009355
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009356 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9357 Sets a variable.
9358
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009359 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9360 Unsets a variable.
9361
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009362 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9363 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9364 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9365 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9366
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009367 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9368 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9369 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9370 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9371 continues.
9372
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009373 - "silent-drop" :
9374 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9375 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9376 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9377 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9378 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9379 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9380 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9381 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9382 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9383 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9384 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9385 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9386 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9387 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9388 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9389 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9390
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009391 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9392 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9393 for changing the default action to a reject.
9394
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009395 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9396 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9397 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9398 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009399 period.
9400
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009401 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9402 declared inline.
9403
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009404 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9405 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009406 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009407 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9408 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009409 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009410 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009411 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009412 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9413 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009414 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009415 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9416 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009417
9418 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9419 followed by some converters.
9420
9421 Example:
9422
9423 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9424
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009425 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9426 <var-name>.
9427
9428 Example:
9429
9430 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9431
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009432 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9433
9434 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9435
9436
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009437tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9438 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9440 no | yes | yes | no
9441 Arguments :
9442 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9443 below.
9444
9445 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9446
9447 Once a session is validated, (ie. after all handshakes have been completed),
9448 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9449 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9450 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9451 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9452 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9453 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9454 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
9455 from the PROXY protocol header (eg: track a source forwarded this way). The
9456 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9457 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9458 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9459 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9460 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9461 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9462 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9463 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9464 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9465 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9466 instead.
9467
9468 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9469 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9470 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9471 rules which may be inserted.
9472
9473 Several types of actions are supported :
9474 - accept : the request is accepted
9475 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9476 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9477 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
9478 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9479 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009480 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009481 - silent-drop
9482
9483 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9484 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9485 sections for a complete description.
9486
9487 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9488 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9489 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9490
9491 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9492 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9493 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9494 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9495 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9496
9497 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9498 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9499
9500 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9501 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9502 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9503
9504 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9505 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9506 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9507
9508 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9509 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9510 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9511
9512 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9513 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9514 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9515
9516 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9517
9518 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9519
9520
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009521tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9522 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9524 no | no | yes | yes
9525 Arguments :
9526 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9527 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9528 as explained at the top of this document.
9529
9530 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9531
9532
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009533timeout check <timeout>
9534 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9535 established.
9536
9537 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9538 yes | no | yes | yes
9539 Arguments:
9540 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9541 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9542 as explained at the top of this document.
9543
9544 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9545 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9546 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9547 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009548 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9549 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9550 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009551
9552 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9553 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9554
9555 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9556 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009557 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009558
9559 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9560 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9561 forget about it.
9562
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009563 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9564 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009565
9566
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009567timeout client <timeout>
9568timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9569 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9570 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9571 yes | yes | yes | no
9572 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009573 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009574 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9575 as explained at the top of this document.
9576
9577 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9578 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9579 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009580 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9581 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9582 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9583 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009584 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9585 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9586 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009587 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009588 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009589 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9590 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009591 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9592 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009593
9594 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9595 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9596 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9597 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9598 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9599 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9600
9601 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9602 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9603 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9604
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009605 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9606 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009607
9608
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009609timeout client-fin <timeout>
9610 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9612 yes | yes | yes | no
9613 Arguments :
9614 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9615 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9616 as explained at the top of this document.
9617
9618 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9619 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9620 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9621 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9622 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9623 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9624 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9625 down in one direction.
9626
9627 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9628 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9629 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9630
9631 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9632
9633
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009634timeout connect <timeout>
9635timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9636 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9638 yes | no | yes | yes
9639 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009640 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009641 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9642 as explained at the top of this document.
9643
9644 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009645 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009646 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009647 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009648 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9649 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009650
9651 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9652 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9653 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9654 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9655 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9656 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9657
9658 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9659 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9660 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9661
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009662 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9663 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009664
9665
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009666timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9667 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9669 yes | yes | yes | yes
9670 Arguments :
9671 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9672 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9673 as explained at the top of this document.
9674
9675 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9676 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9677 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9678 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9679 once the request has started to present itself.
9680
9681 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9682 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9683 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9684 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9685 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9686
9687 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9688 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9689 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9690 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9691
9692 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9693 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9694 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9695 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9696 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009697 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009698
9699 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9700 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9701 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9702 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9703
9704 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9705
9706
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009707timeout http-request <timeout>
9708 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009710 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009711 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009712 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009713 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9714 as explained at the top of this document.
9715
9716 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9717 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9718 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9719 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9720 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9721 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9722 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009723 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9724 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9725 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9726 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9727 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009728 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9729 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009730
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009731 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
9732 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
9733 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
9734 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
9735 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009736 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009737
9738 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9739 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9740 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9741 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9742 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9743
9744 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009745 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9746 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9747 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009748
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009749 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009750 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009751
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009752
9753timeout queue <timeout>
9754 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9756 yes | no | yes | yes
9757 Arguments :
9758 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9759 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9760 as explained at the top of this document.
9761
9762 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9763 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9764 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9765 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9766 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9767
9768 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9769 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9770 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9771 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9772
9773 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9774
9775
9776timeout server <timeout>
9777timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9778 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9779 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9780 yes | no | yes | yes
9781 Arguments :
9782 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9783 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9784 as explained at the top of this document.
9785
9786 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9787 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9788 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9789 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9790 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9791 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9792 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9793
9794 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9795 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9796 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9797 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9798 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009799 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009800 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009801 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
9802 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
9803 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
9804 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009805
9806 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9807 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9808 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9809 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9810 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9811 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9812
9813 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
9814 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
9815 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9816
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009817 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009818
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009819
9820timeout server-fin <timeout>
9821 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
9822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9823 yes | no | yes | yes
9824 Arguments :
9825 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9826 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9827 as explained at the top of this document.
9828
9829 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9830 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9831 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9832 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9833 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
9834 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9835 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9836 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
9837 situations, it should not be needed.
9838
9839 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9840 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9841 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
9842
9843 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
9844
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009845
9846timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009847 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9849 yes | yes | yes | yes
9850 Arguments :
9851 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
9852 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9853 as explained at the top of this document.
9854
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009855 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
9856 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
9857 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
9858 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009859
9860 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9861 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9862 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
9863 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009864 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009865
9866 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9867
9868
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009869timeout tunnel <timeout>
9870 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
9871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9872 yes | no | yes | yes
9873 Arguments :
9874 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9875 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9876 as explained at the top of this document.
9877
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009878 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009879 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
9880 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
9881 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
9882 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
9883 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
9884 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
9885 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
9886 specified.
9887
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009888 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
9889 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
9890 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
9891 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
9892 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
9893 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
9894 state.
9895
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009896 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9897 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9898 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
9899 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
9900 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
9901
9902 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9903 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9904 forget about it.
9905
9906 Example :
9907 defaults http
9908 option http-server-close
9909 timeout connect 5s
9910 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009911 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009912 timeout server 30s
9913 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
9914
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009915 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009916
9917
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009918transparent (deprecated)
9919 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009921 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009922 Arguments : none
9923
9924 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
9925 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9926 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9927 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9928 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9929 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9930 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9931 appropriate server.
9932
9933 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
9934
9935 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9936 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9937
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009938 See also: "option transparent"
9939
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009940unique-id-format <string>
9941 Generate a unique ID for each request.
9942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9943 yes | yes | yes | no
9944 Arguments :
9945 <string> is a log-format string.
9946
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009947 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
9948 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
9949 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
9950 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009951
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009952 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
9953 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
9954 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
9955 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
9956 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
9957 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
9958 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
9959 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009960
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009961 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
9962 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009963
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009964 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009965
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009966 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009967
9968 will generate:
9969
9970 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9971
9972 See also: "unique-id-header"
9973
9974unique-id-header <name>
9975 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
9976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9977 yes | yes | yes | no
9978 Arguments :
9979 <name> is the name of the header.
9980
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009981 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
9982 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009983
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009984 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009985
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009986 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009987 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
9988
9989 will generate:
9990
9991 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9992
9993 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009994
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009995use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009996 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9998 no | yes | yes | no
9999 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010000 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10001 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010002
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010003 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10004 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010005
10006 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10007 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10008 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010009 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
10010 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
10011 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10012 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010013
10014 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10015 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10016 assign the backend.
10017
10018 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10019 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10020 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10021 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10022 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10023 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10024
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010025 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010026 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010027 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10028 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10029 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10030
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010031 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10032 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10033 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10034 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10035 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10036 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10037 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10038 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10039 cannot be forced from the request.
10040
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010041 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010042 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10043 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10044
10045 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10046 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010047
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010048
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010049use-server <server> if <condition>
10050use-server <server> unless <condition>
10051 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10053 no | no | yes | yes
10054 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010055 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010056
10057 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10058
10059 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10060 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10061 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10062
10063 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10064 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10065 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10066 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10067 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10068 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10069 matches will assign the server.
10070
10071 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10072 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10073 with the next rules until one matches.
10074
10075 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10076 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10077 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10078 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10079
10080 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10081 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10082 stripped.
10083
10084 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10085 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10086 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10087 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10088
10089 Example :
10090 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10091 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10092 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10093 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10094 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10095 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010096 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010097 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10098 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10099
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010100 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010101
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010102
101035. Bind and Server options
10104--------------------------
10105
10106The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10107depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10108settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10109written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10110described in this section.
10111
10112
101135.1. Bind options
10114-----------------
10115
10116The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10117as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10118no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10119parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10120while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10121provided immediately after the setting name.
10122
10123The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10124
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010125accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10126 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10127 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10128 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10129 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10130 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10131 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10132 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10133 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10134 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010135 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10136 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10137 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010138
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010139accept-proxy
10140 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010141 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10142 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010143 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10144 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10145 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10146 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
10147 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
10148 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10149 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010150 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10151 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010152
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010153alpn <protocols>
10154 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10155 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10156 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10157 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10158 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
10159 initial NPN extension.
10160
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010161backlog <backlog>
10162 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10163 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10164
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010165curves <curves>
10166 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10167 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10168 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10169 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10170 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10171 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10172
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010173ecdhe <named curve>
10174 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010175 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10176 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010177
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010178ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010179 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10180 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10181 client's certificate.
10182
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010183ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10184 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10185 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10186 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10187 error is ignored.
10188
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010189ca-sign-file <cafile>
10190 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10191 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10192 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10193 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10194 'generate-certificates' for details.
10195
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010196ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010197 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10198 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10199 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10200 'generate-certificates' for details.
10201
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010202ciphers <ciphers>
10203 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10204 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010205 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010206 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
10207 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
10208
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010209crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010210 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10211 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10212 to verify client's certificate.
10213
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010214crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010215 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10216 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10217 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10218 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10219 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10220 file.
10221
10222 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10223 are loaded.
10224
10225 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010226 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010227 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10228 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10229 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10230 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
10231 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10232 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
10233 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010234
10235 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10236 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10237 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10238 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010239 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10240 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010241
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010242 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010243
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010244 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
10245 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +080010246 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010247 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
10248 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10249 clients).
10250
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010251 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10252 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10253 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10254 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10255 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10256 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10257 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10258 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10259 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10260 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10261 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10262 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10263 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10264
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010265 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10266 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10267 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10268 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10269 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10270
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010271 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10272 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10273 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10274 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010275
10276 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10277 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10278 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10279 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10280 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10281 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10282 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10283 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10284 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10285
10286 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10287
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010288 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010289 a cert bundle.
10290
10291 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
10292 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10293 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10294 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10295 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10296 provide multi-cert support.
10297
10298 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10299
10300 Filename | CN | SAN
10301 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10302 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010303 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010304 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10305 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10306
10307 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10308 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10309 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10310 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010311 suites. With BoringSSL multi-cert is natively supported, no need to bundle
10312 certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010313
10314 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10315 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10316
10317 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10318 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10319 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10320
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010321crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010322 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
10323 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010324 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010325 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010326
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010327crt-list <file>
10328 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010329 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10330 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010331
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010332 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10333
10334 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca_file", "crl_file", "ecdhe",
Emmanuel Hocdet4608ed92017-01-20 13:06:27 +010010335 "curves", "ciphers" configuration.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010336 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010337
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010338 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10339 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10340 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10341 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10342 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10343 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10344 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10345 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010346
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010347 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010348 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010349 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL multi-cert is natively supported,
10350 avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can be declared in a
10351 row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010352
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010353 crt-list file example:
10354 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010355 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010356 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010357 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010358
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010359defer-accept
10360 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10361 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10362 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
10363 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
10364 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10365 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10366 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10367 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10368 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10369 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10370 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10371
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010372force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010373 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010374 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010375 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10376 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010377
10378force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010379 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010380 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10381 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010382
10383force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010384 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010385 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10386 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010387
10388force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010389 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010390 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10391 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010392
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010393generate-certificates
10394 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10395 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10396 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10397 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10398 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10399 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10400 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10401 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10402 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10403 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10404 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10405
10406 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10407 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
10408 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
10409 certificate is used many times.
10410
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010411gid <gid>
10412 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10413 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10414 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10415 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10416 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10417
10418group <group>
10419 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10420 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10421 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10422 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10423 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10424
10425id <id>
10426 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10427 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10428 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10429 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10430
10431interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010432 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10433 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10434 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10435 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10436 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10437 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
10438 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010439
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010440level <level>
10441 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10442 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10443 sockets. <level> can be one of :
10444 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
10445 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10446 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10447 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
10448 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
10449 counters).
10450 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
10451 all counters).
10452
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010453maxconn <maxconn>
10454 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10455 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10456 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10457 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10458 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10459 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10460 eat all memory.
10461
10462mode <mode>
10463 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10464 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10465 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10466 UNIX sockets.
10467
10468mss <maxseg>
10469 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10470 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10471 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10472 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10473 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10474 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10475 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10476 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10477 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10478 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10479 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10480
10481name <name>
10482 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10483 page.
10484
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010485namespace <name>
10486 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10487 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10488 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10489 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10490
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010491nice <nice>
10492 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10493 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10494 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10495 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10496 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10497 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10498 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10499 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10500 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10501 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10502 one for an RDP socket.
10503
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010504no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010505 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010506 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010507 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010508 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
10509 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010510 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010511
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010512no-tls-tickets
10513 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10514 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10515 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010516 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10517 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010518
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010519no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010520 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010521 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010522 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010523 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10524 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10525 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010526
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010527no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010528 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010529 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010530 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010531 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10532 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10533 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010534
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010535no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010536 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010537 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010538 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010539 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10540 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10541 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010542
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010543npn <protocols>
10544 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10545 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10546 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10547 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010548 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
10549 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010550
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010551process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
10552 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
10553 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
10554 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
10555 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
10556 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
10557 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
10558 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +020010559 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
10560 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
10561 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
10562 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
10563 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
10564 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
10565 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010566
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010567ssl
10568 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010569 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010570 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10571 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
10572 to deciphered contents.
10573
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010574strict-sni
10575 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10576 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10577 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10578 See the "crt" option for more information.
10579
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010580tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010581 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010582 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10583 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010584 receiving an acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010585 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10586 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10587 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10588 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10589 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10590 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10591 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10592
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010593tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010594 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010595 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10596 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10597 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10598 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10599 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10600 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10601 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010602 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10603 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10604 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010605
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010606tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10607 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10608 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10609 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10610 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10611 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10612 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10613 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10614 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10615 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10616 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10617
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010618transparent
10619 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10620 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10621 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10622 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10623 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10624 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10625 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10626 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10627 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10628 so check for support with your vendor.
10629
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010630v4v6
10631 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10632 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10633 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10634 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010635 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010636
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010637v6only
10638 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10639 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10640 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010641 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10642 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010643
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010644uid <uid>
10645 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10646 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10647 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10648 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10649 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10650
10651user <user>
10652 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10653 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10654 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10655 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
10656 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10657
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010658verify [none|optional|required]
10659 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
10660 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
10661 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
10662 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
10663 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010664 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
10665 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
10666 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
10667 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010668
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200106695.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010670------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010671
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010672The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
10673which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
10674arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
10675settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
10676after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
10677Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
10678address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010679
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010680 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010681 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010682
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010683Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
10684keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
10685
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010686The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010687
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010688addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010689 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010010690 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
10691 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
10692 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
10693 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
10694 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010695
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010696agent-check
10697 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010698 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10699 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10700 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10701 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010702
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010703 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010704 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010705 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10706 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10707 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010708
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020010709 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values in
10710 this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
10711 connections advertised needs to be multipled by the number of load balancers
10712 and different backends that use this health check to get the total number
10713 of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
10714
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010715 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10716 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010717
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010718 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10719 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10720 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010721
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010722 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10723 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10724 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010725
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010726 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10727 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10728 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10729 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
10730 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
10731 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
10732 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010733
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010734 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
10735 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010736
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010737 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
10738 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
10739 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
10740 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
10741 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
10742 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
10743 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
10744 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
10745 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010746
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010747 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
10748 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010749 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
10750 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
10751 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010010752 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010753
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010754 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010755 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010756
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070010757agent-send <string>
10758 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
10759 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
10760 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
10761 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
10762 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
10763
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010764agent-inter <delay>
10765 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
10766 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10767
10768 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
10769 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
10770 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
10771 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
10772 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10773 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10774 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10775 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10776 of backends use the same servers.
10777
10778 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
10779
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010010780agent-addr <addr>
10781 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
10782
10783 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
10784 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
10785 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
10786 hostname, it will be resolved.
10787
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010788agent-port <port>
10789 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
10790
10791 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
10792
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010793backup
10794 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
10795 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
10796 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
10797 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010798 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
10799 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010800
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010801ca-file <cafile>
10802 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10803 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10804 server's certificate.
10805
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010806check
10807 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010010808 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
10809 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
10810 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
10811 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
10812 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
10813 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
10814 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010815 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
10816 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010817 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
10818 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010819
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010820check-send-proxy
10821 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
10822 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
10823 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
10824 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
10825 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
10826 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
10827 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
10828
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010829check-ssl
10830 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
10831 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
10832 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
10833 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010834 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010835 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
10836 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
10837 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010838 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
10839 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010840
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010841ciphers <ciphers>
10842 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010843 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010844 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
10845 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
10846 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
10847 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
10848 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
10849 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
10850
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010851cookie <value>
10852 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
10853 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
10854 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
10855 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
10856 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
10857 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
10858 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
10859
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010860crl-file <crlfile>
10861 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10862 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10863 to verify server's certificate.
10864
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020010865crt <cert>
10866 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10867 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
10868 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
10869 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
10870 certificate request.
10871
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010872disabled
10873 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
10874 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
10875 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
10876 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
10877 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010878 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010879
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010880enabled
10881 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
10882 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
10883 default value.
10884 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
10885 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010886
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010887error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010888 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
10889 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
10890 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010891
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010892 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010893
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010894fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010895 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
10896 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
10897 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
10898
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010899force-sslv3
10900 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
10901 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010902 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010903 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-force-sslv3", "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010904
10905force-tlsv10
10906 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010907 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010908 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-force-tlsv10", "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010909
10910force-tlsv11
10911 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010912 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010913 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-force-tlsv11", "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010914
10915force-tlsv12
10916 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010917 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010918 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-force-tlsv12", "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010919
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010920id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020010921 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
10922 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
10923 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010924
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010925init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
10926 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
10927 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
10928 turn each of the methods mentionned in the comma-delimited list. The first
10929 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
10930 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
10931 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
10932 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
10933 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
10934 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
10935 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
10936 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
10937 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
10938 server (eg: filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
10939 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
10940 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
10941 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
10942 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
10943 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
10944 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
10945 historic behaviour.
10946
10947 Example:
10948 defaults
10949 # never fail on address resolution
10950 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
10951
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010952inter <delay>
10953fastinter <delay>
10954downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010955 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
10956 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10957 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
10958 between checks depending on the server state :
10959
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020010960 Server state | Interval used
10961 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10962 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
10963 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10964 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
10965 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
10966 or yet unchecked. |
10967 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10968 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
10969 | "inter" otherwise.
10970 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010971
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010972 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
10973 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
10974 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
10975 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010976 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10977 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10978 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10979 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10980 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010981
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010982maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010983 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
10984 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
10985 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
10986 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
10987 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
10988 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
10989 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
10990 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
10991
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010992maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010993 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
10994 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
10995 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
10996 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
10997 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
10998 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
10999 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11000
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011001minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011002 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11003 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11004 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11005 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11006 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11007 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011008 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011009 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011010
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011011namespace <name>
11012 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11013 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11014 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11015 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11016
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011017no-agent-check
11018 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11019 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11020 default value.
11021 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11022 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11023
11024no-backup
11025 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11026 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11027 default value.
11028 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11029 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11030
11031no-check
11032 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11033 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11034 default value.
11035 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11036 "default-server" "check" setting.
11037
11038no-check-ssl
11039 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11040 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11041 default value.
11042 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11043 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11044
11045no-force-sslv3
11046 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "force-sslv3"
11047 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11048 default value.
11049 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11050 "default-server" "force-sslv3" setting.
11051
11052no-force-tlsv10
11053 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "force-tlsv10"
11054 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11055 default value.
11056 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11057 "default-server" "force-tlsv10" setting.
11058
11059no-force-tlsv11
11060 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "force-tlsv11"
11061 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11062 default value.
11063 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11064 "default-server" "force-tlsv11" setting.
11065
11066no-force-tlsv12
11067 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "force-tlsv12"
11068 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11069 default value.
11070 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11071 "default-server" "force-tlsv12" setting.
11072
11073no-send-proxy
11074 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11075 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11076 default value.
11077 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11078 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11079
11080no-send-proxy-v2
11081 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11082 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11083 default value.
11084 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11085 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11086
11087no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11088 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11089 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11090 default value.
11091 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11092 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11093
11094no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11095 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11096 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11097 default value.
11098 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11099 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11100
11101no-ssl
11102 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11103 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11104 default value.
11105 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11106 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11107
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011108no-ssl-reuse
11109 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11110 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11111 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11112 and for paranoid users.
11113
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011114no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011115 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11116 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011117 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011118
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011119no-tls-tickets
11120 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11121 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11122 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011123 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11124 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011125 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011126
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011127no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011128 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011129 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11130 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011131 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11132 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011133 See also "tlsv10", "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011134
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011135no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011136 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011137 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11138 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011139 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11140 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011141 See also "tlsv11", "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011142
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011143no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011144 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011145 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11146 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011147 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11148 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011149 See also "tlsv12", "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011150
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011151no-verifyhost
11152 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11153 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11154 default value.
11155 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11156 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011157
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011158non-stick
11159 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11160 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11161 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11162
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011163observe <mode>
11164 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11165 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11166 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11167 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11168 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11169 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011170 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011171
11172 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11173
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011174on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011175 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11176 Currently, four modes are available:
11177 - fastinter: force fastinter
11178 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11179 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11180 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11181 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11182
11183 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11184
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011185on-marked-down <action>
11186 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11187 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011188 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11189 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11190 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11191 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11192 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11193 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11194 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11195 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011196
11197 Actions are disabled by default
11198
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011199on-marked-up <action>
11200 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11201 Currently one action is available:
11202 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11203 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11204 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11205 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
11206 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11207 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
11208 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11209 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11210
11211 Actions are disabled by default
11212
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011213port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011214 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11215 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11216 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11217 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11218 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11219 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11220
11221redir <prefix>
11222 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11223 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11224 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11225 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11226 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11227 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11228 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11229 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011230 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011231 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
11232 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11233 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11234 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11235 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11236
11237 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11238
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011239rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011240 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11241 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11242 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11243
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011244resolve-prefer <family>
11245 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11246 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11247 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11248 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11249
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011250 Default value: ipv6
11251
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011252 Example:
11253
11254 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011255
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011256resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
11257 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
11258 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011259 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011260 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11261 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
11262 configured network, another address is selected.
11263
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011264 Example:
11265
11266 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011267
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011268resolvers <id>
11269 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11270 hostname.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011271 In order to be operational, DNS resolution requires that health check is
11272 enabled on the server. Actually, health checks triggers the DNS resolution.
11273 You must precise one 'resolvers' parameter on each server line where DNS
11274 resolution is required.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011275
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011276 Example:
11277
11278 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011279
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011280 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011281
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011282send-proxy
11283 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11284 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11285 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11286 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011287 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11288 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11289 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11290 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11291 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11292 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11293 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11294 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11295 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11296 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011297 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
11298 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011299
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011300send-proxy-v2
11301 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11302 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11303 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11304 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11305 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011306 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the
11307 "no-send-proxy-v2" option of this section and send-proxy" option of the
11308 "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011309
11310send-proxy-v2-ssl
11311 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11312 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11313 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11314 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11315 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11316 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
11317 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011318 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
11319 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011320
11321send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11322 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11323 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11324 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11325 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11326 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11327 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
11328 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
11329 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011330 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and the
11331 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011332
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011333slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011334 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
11335 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
11336 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
11337 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
11338 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
11339 parameters :
11340
11341 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
11342 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
11343
11344 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
11345 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
11346 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
11347 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
11348
11349 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
11350 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
11351 seen as failed.
11352
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011353sni <expression>
11354 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
11355 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
11356 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
11357 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
11358 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense.
11359
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011360source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011361source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011362source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011363 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
11364 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
11365 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
11366 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
11367
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011368 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
11369 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
11370 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
11371 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
11372 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
11373 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
11374 server.
11375
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000011376 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
11377 specifying the source address without port(s).
11378
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011379ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011380 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
11381 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
11382 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
11383 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
11384 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
11385 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011386 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
11387 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011388
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011389sslv3
11390 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-sslv3"
11391 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11392 default value.
11393 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11394 "default-server" "no-sslv3" setting.
11395
11396ssl-reuse
11397 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
11398 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11399 default value.
11400 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11401 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
11402
11403stick
11404 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
11405 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11406 default value.
11407 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11408 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011409
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011410tcp-ut <delay>
11411 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
11412 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
11413 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011414 acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011415 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
11416 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
11417 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
11418 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
11419 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
11420 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
11421 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
11422 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
11423 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11424
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011425track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020011426 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
11427 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
11428 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
11429 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011430 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
11431
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011432tlsv10
11433 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tlsv10"
11434 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11435 default value.
11436 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11437 "default-server" "no-tlsv10" setting.
11438
11439tlsv11
11440 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tlsv11"
11441 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11442 default value.
11443 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11444 "default-server" "no-tlsv11" setting.
11445
11446tlsv12
11447 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tlsv12"
11448 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11449 default value.
11450 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11451 "default-server" "no-tlsv12" setting.
11452
11453tls-tickets
11454 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
11455 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11456 default value.
11457 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11458 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011459
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011460verify [none|required]
11461 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010011462 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
11463 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
11464 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
11465 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011466 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
11467 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
11468 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011469
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011470verifyhost <hostname>
11471 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
11472 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
11473 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
11474 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
11475 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
11476 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011477 See also "no-verifyhost" option.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011478
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011479weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011480 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
11481 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
11482 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020011483 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
11484 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
11485 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
11486 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
11487 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
11488 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011489
11490
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200114915.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
11492-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011493
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011494HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
11495using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
11496configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011497This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
11498can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
11499workload.
11500This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
11501resolution at run time.
11502Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
11503carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
11504
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011505Bear in mind that DNS resolution is triggered by health checks. This makes
11506health checks mandatory to allow DNS resolution.
11507
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011508
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200115095.3.1. Global overview
11510----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011511
11512As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
11513different steps of the process life:
11514
11515 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
11516 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
11517 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
11518
11519 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
11520 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
11521 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
11522
11523A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
11524 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
11525 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
11526 resolution to know this new IP.
11527
11528A few things important to notice:
11529 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
11530 first valid response.
11531
11532 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
11533 servers return an error.
11534
11535
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200115365.3.2. The resolvers section
11537----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011538
11539This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
11540HAProxy.
11541There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
11542many name servers.
11543
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011544When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
11545uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
11546is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
11547answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
11548
11549When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
11550used by HAProxy to decide what type of behavior to apply.
11551
11552Two types of behavior can be applied:
11553 1. stop DNS resolution
11554 2. replay the DNS query with a new query type
11555 In such case, the following types are applied in this exact order:
11556 1. ANY query type
11557 2. query type corresponding to family pointed by resolve-prefer
11558 server's parameter
11559 3. remaining family type
11560
11561HAProxy stops DNS resolution when the following errors occur:
11562 - invalid DNS response packet
11563 - wrong name in the query section of the response
11564 - NX domain
11565 - Query refused by server
11566 - CNAME not pointing to an IP address
11567
11568HAProxy tries a new query type when the following errors occur:
11569 - no Answer records in the response
11570 - DNS response truncated
11571 - Error in DNS response
11572 - No expected DNS records found in the response
11573 - name server timeout
11574
11575For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section:
11576 - first response is valid and is applied directly, second response is ignored
11577 - first response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
11578 applied;
11579 - first response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
11580 HAProxy replays the query with a new type;
11581 - first response is truncated and second one is a NX Domain, then HAProxy
11582 stops resolution.
11583
11584
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011585resolvers <resolvers id>
11586 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
11587
11588A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
11589
11590nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
11591 DNS server description:
11592 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
11593 <ip> : IP address of the server
11594 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
11595
11596hold <status> <period>
11597 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
11598 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011599 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
11600 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011601 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
11602 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11603 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
11604
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011605 Default value is 10s for "valid" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011606
11607 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
11608 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
11609 the healch check.
11610
11611resolve_retries <nb>
11612 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
11613 giving up.
11614 Default value: 3
11615
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011616 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
11617 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
11618 type.
11619
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011620timeout <event> <time>
11621 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
11622 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
11623 events available are:
11624 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
11625 been received.
11626 Default value: 1s
11627 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11628 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
11629
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011630 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011631
11632 resolvers mydns
11633 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
11634 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
11635 resolve_retries 3
11636 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011637 hold other 30s
11638 hold refused 30s
11639 hold nx 30s
11640 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011641 hold valid 10s
11642
11643
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116446. HTTP header manipulation
11645---------------------------
11646
11647In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
11648response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
11649request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
11650which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011651against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011652
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011653If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
11654to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
11655but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
11656HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
11657stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
11658because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
11659a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
11660still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020011661
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011662This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
11663in section 4.2 :
11664
11665 - reqadd <string>
11666 - reqallow <search>
11667 - reqiallow <search>
11668 - reqdel <search>
11669 - reqidel <search>
11670 - reqdeny <search>
11671 - reqideny <search>
11672 - reqpass <search>
11673 - reqipass <search>
11674 - reqrep <search> <replace>
11675 - reqirep <search> <replace>
11676 - reqtarpit <search>
11677 - reqitarpit <search>
11678 - rspadd <string>
11679 - rspdel <search>
11680 - rspidel <search>
11681 - rspdeny <search>
11682 - rspideny <search>
11683 - rsprep <search> <replace>
11684 - rspirep <search> <replace>
11685
11686With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
11687is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
11688parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
11689prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
11690Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
11691
11692 \t for a tab
11693 \r for a carriage return (CR)
11694 \n for a new line (LF)
11695 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
11696 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
11697 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
11698 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
11699 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
11700
11701The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
11702portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
11703above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
11704regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
117059 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
11706is very common to users of the "sed" program.
11707
11708The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
11709after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
11710
11711Notes related to these keywords :
11712---------------------------------
11713 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
11714 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
11715 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
11716
11717 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
11718 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
11719 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
11720
11721 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
11722 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
11723 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
11724 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
11725 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
11726
11727 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
11728 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
11729 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
11730 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
11731 useless headers before adding new ones.
11732
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011733 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011734 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
11735
11736 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
11737 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
11738 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
11739
11740 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
11741 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011742 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011743
11744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200117457. Using ACLs and fetching samples
11746----------------------------------
11747
11748Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
11749client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
11750The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
11751these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
11752but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
11753data called patterns.
11754
11755
117567.1. ACL basics
11757---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011758
11759The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
11760content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
11761from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
11762simple :
11763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011764 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011765 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011766 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
11767 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011769The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
11770adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011771
11772In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
11773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011774 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011775
11776This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
11777Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
11778and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011779an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
11780conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
11781as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
11782are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011783
11784ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
11785'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
11786which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
11787
11788There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
11789performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
11790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011791The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
11792specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
11793this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011794methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
11795ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011796
11797Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
11798 - boolean
11799 - integer (signed or unsigned)
11800 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
11801 - string
11802 - data block
11803
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011804Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
11805converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
11806would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
11807The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
11808which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
11809
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011810Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
11811keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
11812fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
11813which are summarized in the table below :
11814
11815 +---------------------+-----------------+
11816 | Sample or converter | Default |
11817 | output type | matching method |
11818 +---------------------+-----------------+
11819 | boolean | bool |
11820 +---------------------+-----------------+
11821 | integer | int |
11822 +---------------------+-----------------+
11823 | ip | ip |
11824 +---------------------+-----------------+
11825 | string | str |
11826 +---------------------+-----------------+
11827 | binary | none, use "-m" |
11828 +---------------------+-----------------+
11829
11830Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
11831matching method, see below.
11832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011833The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
11834 - boolean
11835 - integer or integer range
11836 - IP address / network
11837 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
11838 - regular expression
11839 - hex block
11840
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011841The following ACL flags are currently supported :
11842
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011843 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
11844 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011845 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011846 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011847 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011848 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011849 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
11850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011851The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
11852read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
11853if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
11854lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
11855will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
11856beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
11857a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
11858lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
11859exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
11860
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011861The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
11862parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
11863ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
11864a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
11865check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
11866
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011867The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
11868socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
11869file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
11870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011871Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
11872loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
11873
11874 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
11875
11876In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
11877the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
11878case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
11879as well.
11880
11881The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
11882sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
11883do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
11884methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
11885is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
11886obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
11887followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
11888default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
11889that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
11890string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
11891
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011892The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
11893By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
11894string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
11895resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
11896server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
11897waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
11898flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
11899function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
11900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011901There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
11902sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
11903be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011904
11905 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
11906 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011907 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
11908 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
11909 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
11910 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011911
11912 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
11913 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011914 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011915
11916 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011917 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011918
11919 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011920 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011921
11922 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
11923 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
11924
11925 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
11926 binary or string samples.
11927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011928 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
11929 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011931 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
11932 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
11933 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011935 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
11936 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011938 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
11939 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011941 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
11942 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011944 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
11945 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011946 This may be used with binary or string samples.
11947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011948 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
11949 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
11950 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011951
11952For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
11953request, it is possible to do :
11954
11955 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
11956
11957In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
11958buffer, one would use the following acl :
11959
11960 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
11961
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011962On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
11963possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
11964
11965 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
11966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011967All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
11968criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
11969method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
11970to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
11971criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
11972the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011974If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011975the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
11976For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011978 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
11979 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
11980 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
11981 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011982
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011983
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011984The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
11985types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
11986combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
11987brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
11988default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011990 +-------------------------------------------------+
11991 | Input sample type |
11992 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011993 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011994 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11995 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
11996 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011997 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011998 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011999 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012000 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012001 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012002 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012003 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012004 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012005 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012006 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012007 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012008 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012009 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012010 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012011 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012012 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012013 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012014 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012015 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012016 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012017 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012018 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12019 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12020 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012021
12022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200120237.1.1. Matching booleans
12024------------------------
12025
12026In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12027Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12028When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12029that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12030
12031Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12032return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12033"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12034
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200120367.1.2. Matching integers
12037------------------------
12038
12039Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12040enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12041to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12042
12043Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12044matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12045lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012046
12047For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12048unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12049representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12050
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012051As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12052two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12053instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12054ranges and operators.
12055
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012056For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012057operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12058Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12059of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012060
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012061Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012062
12063 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12064 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12065 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12066 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12067 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12068
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012069For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012070
12071 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12072
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012073This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12074
12075 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12076
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200120787.1.3. Matching strings
12079-----------------------
12080
12081String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12082different forms :
12083
12084 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
12085 patterns ;
12086
12087 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
12088 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
12089
12090 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12091 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12092
12093 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12094 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12095
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012096 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012097 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12098 matches.
12099
12100 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12101 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12102 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012103
12104String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12105exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12106characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12107string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12108to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012109before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012110
12111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200121127.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12113---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012114
12115Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12116they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12117possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12118passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12119the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012120the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12121match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012122
12123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200121247.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12125-------------------------------------
12126
12127It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12128not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12129a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12130to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12131digits may be used upper or lower case.
12132
12133Example :
12134 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12135 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12136
12137
121387.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12139---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012140
12141IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12142netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12143within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012144host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012145difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12146at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12147does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12148parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012149
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012150The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12151abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12152
12153 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12154 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12155 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12156 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12157 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12158 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12159 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12160 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12161
12162Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12163192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12164
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012165IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12166Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12167trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12168IPv6 patterns.
12169
12170HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12171following situations :
12172 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12173 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12174 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12175 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12176 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12177 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12178 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12179 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12180 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12181 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012183
121847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12185----------------------------------
12186
12187Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12188combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12189
12190 - AND (implicit)
12191 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12192 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012194A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012196 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012198Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
12199indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012201For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
12202"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
12203requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
12204is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
12205
12206 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012207 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
12208 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
12209 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012210
12211To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
12212and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
12213
12214 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
12215 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
12216 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
12217 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
12218
12219 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
12220 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
12221 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
12222 use_backend www if host_www
12223
12224It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
12225expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
12226be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
12227the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
12228
12229 The following rule :
12230
12231 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012232 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012233
12234 Can also be written that way :
12235
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012236 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012237
12238It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
12239to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
12240simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
12241sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
12242good use is the following :
12243
12244 With named ACLs :
12245
12246 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
12247 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
12248 monitor fail if site_dead
12249
12250 With anonymous ACLs :
12251
12252 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
12253
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012254See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
12255keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012256
12257
122587.3. Fetching samples
12259---------------------
12260
12261Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
12262against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
12263sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
12264ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
12265of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
12266available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
12267
12268This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
12269Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
12270compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
12271deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
12272
12273The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
12274matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
12275method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
12276indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
12277
12278As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
12279when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
12280mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
12281the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
12282ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
12283
12284Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
12285multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
12286when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
12287incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
12288are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
12289is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
12290all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
12291
12292Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
12293 - name
12294 - name(arg1)
12295 - name(arg1,arg2)
12296
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012297
122987.3.1. Converters
12299-----------------
12300
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012301Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
12302of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
12303is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
12304was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
12305has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
12306unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
12307
12308These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
12309sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
12310the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
12311support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012312
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012313A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
12314support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
12315supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
12316(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
12317bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
12318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012319The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012320
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001232151d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
12322 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
12323 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
12324 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
12325 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
12326 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
12327
12328 Example :
12329 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
12330 # containg values for the three properties requested by using the
12331 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
12332 frontend http-in
12333 bind *:8081
12334 default_backend servers
12335 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
12336 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
12337
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012338add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012339 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012340 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012341 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
12342 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012343 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012344 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12345 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12346 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12347 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12348 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012349 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012350
12351and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012352 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012353 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012354 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12355 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012356 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012357 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12358 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12359 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12360 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12361 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012362 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012363
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012364base64
12365 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
12366 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
12367 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
12368
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012369bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012370 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012371 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12372 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12373 presence of a flag).
12374
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012375bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
12376 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
12377 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012378 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012379
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012380cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012381 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
12382 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012383
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012384crc32([<avalanche>])
12385 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
12386 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12387 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12388 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12389 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12390 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
12391 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
12392 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
12393 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
12394 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
12395 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
12396
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010012397da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012398 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
12399 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
12400 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
12401 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012402 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012403 configuration language.
12404
12405 Example:
12406 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020012407 bind *:8881
12408 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012409 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012410
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020012411debug
12412 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
12413 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
12414 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
12415
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012416div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012417 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12418 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012419 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012420 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12421 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012422 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012423 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12424 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12425 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12426 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12427 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012428 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012429
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012430djb2([<avalanche>])
12431 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
12432 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12433 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12434 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12435 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12436 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12437 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012438 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
12439 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012440
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012441even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012442 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012443 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
12444
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010012445field(<index>,<delimiters>)
12446 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
12447 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
12448 list of chars.
12449
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012450hex
12451 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
12452 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
12453 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
12454 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010012455
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012456http_date([<offset>])
12457 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12458 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
12459 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
12460 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
12461 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
12462 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012463
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012464in_table(<table>)
12465 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12466 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
12467 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
12468 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
12469 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
12470
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012471ipmask(<mask>)
12472 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
12473 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
12474 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
12475 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
12476
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012477json([<input-code>])
12478 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
12479 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012480 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012481 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
12482 of errors:
12483 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
12484 bytes, ...)
12485 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
12486 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
12487
12488 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
12489 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
12490 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
12491 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
12492 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
12493 are :
12494 - "ascii" : never fails ;
12495 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
12496 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
12497 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
12498 error ;
12499 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
12500 characters corresponding to the other errors.
12501
12502 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
12503 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
12504
12505 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012506 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012507 capture request header user-agent len 150
12508 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012509
12510 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
12511 GET / HTTP/1.0
12512 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
12513
12514 Output log:
12515 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
12516
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012517language(<value>[,<default>])
12518 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
12519 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
12520 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
12521 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
12522 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
12523 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
12524 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
12525 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
12526 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
12527 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
12528 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
12529 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012530
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012531 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012532
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012533 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
12534 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012535
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012536 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
12537 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
12538 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
12539 use_backend spanish if es
12540 use_backend french if fr
12541 use_backend english if en
12542 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012543
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012544lower
12545 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
12546 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12547 type. The result is of type string.
12548
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012549ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
12550 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12551 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
12552 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12553 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12554 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12555 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
12556
12557 Example :
12558
12559 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
12560 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12561 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12562
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012563map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12564map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12565map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12566 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
12567 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
12568 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
12569 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
12570 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
12571 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
12572 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
12573 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012574
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012575 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
12576 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
12577 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012578
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012579 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012580 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012581
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012582 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
12583 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12584 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
12585 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020012586 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
12587 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012588 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
12589 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12590 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
12591 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12592 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
12593 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12594 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
12595 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080012596 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
12597 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12598 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012599 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12600 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
12601 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12602 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
12603 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012604
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012605 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
12606 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
12607 the corresponding match text.
12608
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012609 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
12610 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
12611 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
12612 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
12613 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012614
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012615 Example :
12616
12617 # this is a comment and is ignored
12618 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
12619 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
12620 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
12621 | | | `---------- value
12622 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
12623 | `---------------------------- key
12624 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
12625
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012626mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012627 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12628 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012629 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012630 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012631 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012632 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12633 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12634 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12635 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12636 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012637 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012638
12639mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012640 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020012641 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
12642 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012643 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012644 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012645 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012646 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12647 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12648 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12649 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12650 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012651 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012652
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010012653nbsrv
12654 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
12655 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
12656 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
12657 map lookup.
12658
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012659neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012660 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
12661 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
12662 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
12663 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012664
12665not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012666 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012667 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12668 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12669 absence of a flag).
12670
12671odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012672 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012673 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
12674
12675or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012676 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012677 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012678 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12679 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012680 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012681 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12682 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12683 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12684 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12685 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012686 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012687
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010012688regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012689 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
12690 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
12691 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
12692 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
12693 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
12694 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
12695 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
12696 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
12697 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
12698 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010012699 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
12700 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
12701 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
12702 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012703
12704 Example :
12705
12706 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
12707 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
12708 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
12709 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
12710
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012711capture-req(<id>)
12712 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
12713 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12714
12715 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012716 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12717 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012718
12719capture-res(<id>)
12720 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
12721 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12722
12723 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012724 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12725 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012726
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012727sdbm([<avalanche>])
12728 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
12729 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12730 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12731 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12732 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12733 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12734 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012735 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
12736 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012737
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012738set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012739 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
12740 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
12741 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012742 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012743 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12744 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012745 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012746 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12747 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012748 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012749 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012750
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012751sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012752 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
12753 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012754 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012755 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12756 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012757 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012758 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12759 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012760 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012761 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12762 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012763 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012764 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012765
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012766table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
12767 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12768 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12769 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
12770 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12771 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12772 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
12773
12774
12775table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
12776 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12777 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12778 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
12779 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12780 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12781 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
12782
12783table_conn_cnt(<table>)
12784 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12785 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12786 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12787 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
12788 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12789
12790table_conn_cur(<table>)
12791 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12792 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12793 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12794 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12795 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
12796
12797table_conn_rate(<table>)
12798 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12799 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12800 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
12801 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12802 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
12803
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012804table_gpt0(<table>)
12805 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12806 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
12807 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12808 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12809 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
12810
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012811table_gpc0(<table>)
12812 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12813 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12814 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12815 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
12816 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
12817
12818table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
12819 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12820 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12821 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
12822 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
12823 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
12824 sample fetch keyword.
12825
12826table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
12827 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12828 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12829 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12830 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12831 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12832
12833table_http_err_rate(<table>)
12834 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12835 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12836 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
12837 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
12838 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
12839 keyword.
12840
12841table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
12842 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12843 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12844 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12845 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
12846 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12847
12848table_http_req_rate(<table>)
12849 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12850 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12851 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
12852 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
12853 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
12854 keyword.
12855
12856table_kbytes_in(<table>)
12857 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12858 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12859 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
12860 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12861 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12862 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
12863 keyword.
12864
12865table_kbytes_out(<table>)
12866 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12867 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12868 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
12869 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12870 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12871 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
12872 keyword.
12873
12874table_server_id(<table>)
12875 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12876 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12877 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
12878 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
12879 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
12880 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
12881
12882table_sess_cnt(<table>)
12883 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12884 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12885 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12886 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
12887 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12888 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
12889 keyword.
12890
12891table_sess_rate(<table>)
12892 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12893 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12894 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
12895 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
12896 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12897 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
12898 keyword.
12899
12900table_trackers(<table>)
12901 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12902 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12903 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12904 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
12905 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
12906 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
12907 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
12908 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
12909 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
12910 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
12911
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012912upper
12913 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
12914 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12915 type. The result is of type string.
12916
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020012917url_dec
12918 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
12919 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
12920
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012921unset-var(<var name>)
12922 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
12923 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12924 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
12925 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12926 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
12927 response),
12928 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12929 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
12930 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12931 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
12932
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012933utime(<format>[,<offset>])
12934 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12935 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
12936 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12937 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12938 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12939 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
12940
12941 Example :
12942
12943 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
12944 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12945 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12946
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010012947word(<index>,<delimiters>)
12948 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
12949 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
12950
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012951wt6([<avalanche>])
12952 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
12953 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12954 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12955 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12956 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12957 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12958 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012959 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
12960 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012961
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012962xor(<value>)
12963 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012964 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012965 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012966 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012967 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012968 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12969 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012970 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012971 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12972 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012973 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012974 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012975
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010012976xxh32([<seed>])
12977 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
12978 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
12979 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
12980 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
12981 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
12982 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
12983 as cryptographically secure.
12984
12985xxh64([<seed>])
12986 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
12987 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
12988 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
12989 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
12990 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
12991 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
12992 as cryptographically secure.
12993
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012994
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200129957.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012996--------------------------------------------
12997
12998A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
12999not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
13000"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
13001The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
13002
13003always_false : boolean
13004 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13005 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13006
13007always_true : boolean
13008 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13009 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13010
13011avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013012 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013013 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
13014 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
13015 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
13016 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
13017 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
13018 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
13019 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
13020 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
13021 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
13022 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
13023 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
13024 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
13025 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010013026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013027be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013028 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
13029 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
13030 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
13031 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
13032 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013034be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
13035 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13036 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13037 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
13038 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
13039 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
13040 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013041
13042 Example :
13043 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
13044 backend dynamic
13045 mode http
13046 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
13047 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013048
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013049bin(<hexa>) : bin
13050 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
13051 of the string.
13052
13053bool(<bool>) : bool
13054 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
13055 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
13056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013057connslots([<backend>]) : integer
13058 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013059 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013060 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
13061 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050013062
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013063 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013064 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013065 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
13066
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013067 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
13068 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013069
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013070 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013071 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013072 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013073 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
13074 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013075 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013076 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013077
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013078 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
13079 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013080 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013081 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013082
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013083date([<offset>]) : integer
13084 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
13085 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
13086 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
13087 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020013088 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
13089
13090 Example :
13091
13092 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
13093 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013094
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020013095env(<name>) : string
13096 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
13097 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
13098 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
13099 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
13100 certain way.
13101
13102 Examples :
13103 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
13104 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
13105
13106 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
13107 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
13108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013109fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
13110 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013111 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
13112 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013113 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
13114 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
13115 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
13116 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
13117 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013118
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020013119fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13120 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
13121 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
13122 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
13123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013124fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13125 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13126 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13127 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
13128 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
13129 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
13130 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
13131 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
13132 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013133
13134 Example :
13135 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
13136 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
13137 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
13138 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
13139 frontend mail
13140 bind :25
13141 mode tcp
13142 maxconn 100
13143 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
13144 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
13145 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
13146 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013147
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010013148hostname : string
13149 Returns the system hostname.
13150
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013151int(<integer>) : signed integer
13152 Returns a signed integer.
13153
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013154ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
13155 Returns an ipv4.
13156
13157ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
13158 Returns an ipv6.
13159
13160meth(<method>) : method
13161 Returns a method.
13162
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013163nbproc : integer
13164 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
13165 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
13166 and debugging purposes.
13167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013168nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
13169 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
13170 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
13171 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013172 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
13173 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
13174 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013175
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013176proc : integer
13177 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
13178 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
13179 debugging purposes.
13180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013181queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013182 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
13183 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
13184 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013185 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
13186 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
13187 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
13188 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
13189 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
13190
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010013191rand([<range>]) : integer
13192 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
13193 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
13194 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
13195 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
13196 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
13197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013198srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13199 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13200 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
13201 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
13202 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
13203 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
13204 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
13205 methods.
13206
13207srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
13208 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
13209 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
13210 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
13211 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
13212 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
13213 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
13214 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
13215
13216srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13217 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13218 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013219 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013220 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
13221 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
13222 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
13223 overloading servers).
13224
13225 Example :
13226 # Redirect to a separate back
13227 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
13228 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
13229 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
13230
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013231stopping : boolean
13232 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
13233 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
13234 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
13235
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013236str(<string>) : string
13237 Returns a string.
13238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013239table_avl([<table>]) : integer
13240 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
13241 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
13242
13243table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13244 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
13245 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
13246 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
13247
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013248var(<var-name>) : undefined
13249 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013250 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
13251 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013252 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013253 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13254 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013255 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013256 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13257 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013258 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013259 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013260
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200132617.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013262----------------------------------
13263
13264The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
13265closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
13266methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
13267sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
13268TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013269the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
13270counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
13271"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013272argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
13273the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
13274this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013275
13276be_id : integer
13277 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
13278 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13279
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013280be_name : string
13281 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
13282 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013284dst : ip
13285 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
13286 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
13287 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
13288 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
13289 RFC 4291.
13290
13291dst_conn : integer
13292 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13293 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
13294 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
13295 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
13296 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
13297 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
13298 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
13299 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013300
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013301dst_is_local : boolean
13302 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
13303 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
13304 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
13305 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
13306 targetting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
13307 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
13308 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
13309 it only once per connection.
13310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013311dst_port : integer
13312 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
13313 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
13314 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
13315 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
13316 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
13317 an HTTP header.
13318
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010013319fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
13320 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
13321 header.
13322
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020013323fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
13324 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
13325 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
13326 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
13327 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13328 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13329 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13330
13331fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
13332 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
13333 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
13334 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
13335 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13336 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13337 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13338
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070013339fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
13340 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13341 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13342 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13343 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13344
13345fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
13346 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13347 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13348 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13349 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13350
13351fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
13352 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
13353 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13354 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13355 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13356
13357fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
13358 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
13359 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13360 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13361 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13362
13363fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
13364 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
13365 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13366 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13367 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13368
13369fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
13370 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
13371 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13372 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13373 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013375fe_id : integer
13376 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010013377 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013378 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13379
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013380fe_name : string
13381 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
13382 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
13383 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13384
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013385sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013386sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13387sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13388sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013389 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
13390 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13391 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
13392
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013393sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013394sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13395sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13396sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013397 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
13398 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13399 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
13400
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013401sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013402sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13403sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13404sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013405 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
13406 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013407 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
13408 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
13409 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013410
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013411 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013412 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13413 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013414 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13415 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
13416 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013417 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13418 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13419
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013420sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013421sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13422sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13423sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013424 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
13425 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
13426
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013427sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013428sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13429sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13430sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013431 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13432 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
13433 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
13434
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013435sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013436sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13437sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13438sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013439 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
13440 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
13441 See also src_conn_rate.
13442
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013443sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013444sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13445sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13446sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013447 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013448 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013449
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013450sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
13451sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13452sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13453sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13454 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13455 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
13456
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013457sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013458sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13459sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13460sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013461 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
13462 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
13463 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013464 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13465 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13466 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013467
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013468sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013469sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13470sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13471sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013472 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
13473 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
13474 See also src_http_err_cnt.
13475
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013476sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013477sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13478sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13479sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013480 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
13481 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13482 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
13483 src_http_err_rate.
13484
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013485sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013486sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13487sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13488sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013489 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13490 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13491 src_http_req_cnt.
13492
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013493sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013494sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13495sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13496sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013497 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13498 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
13499 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13500 src_http_req_rate.
13501
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013502sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013503sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13504sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13505sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013506 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013507 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
13508 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
13509 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
13510 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013511
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013512 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013513 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13514 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013515 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13516
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013517sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013518sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13519sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13520sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013521 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
13522 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13523 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013524
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013525sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013526sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13527sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13528sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013529 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
13530 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13531 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013532
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013533sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013534sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13535sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13536sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013537 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
13538 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
13539 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
13540 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013541 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013542 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
13543
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013544sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013545sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13546sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13547sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013548 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
13549 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13550 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
13551 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
13552 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013553 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013554
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013555sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013556sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13557sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13558sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020013559 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
13560 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
13561 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
13562
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013563sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013564sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13565sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13566sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013567 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13568 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013569 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013570 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
13571 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013572 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
13573 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
13574 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013576so_id : integer
13577 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
13578 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
13579 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013581src : ip
13582 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
13583 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
13584 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
13585 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013586 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
13587 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
13588 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
13589 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013590
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013591 Example:
13592 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
13593 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
13594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013595src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13596 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
13597 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
13598 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013599 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013601src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13602 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
13603 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013604 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013605 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013607src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13608 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13609 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13610 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
13611 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
13612 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
13613 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013614
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013615 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013616 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13617 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
13618 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
13619 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013620 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013621 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13622 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013624src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013625 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013626 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013627 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013628 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013630src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013631 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013632 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
13633 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013634 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013636src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13637 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
13638 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13639 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013640 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013642src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013643 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013644 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013645 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013646 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013647
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013648src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13649 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13650 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
13651 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
13652 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
13653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013654src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013655 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013656 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013657 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
13658 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013659 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13660 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13661 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013663src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13664 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
13665 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013666 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013667 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013668 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013670src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13671 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
13672 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13673 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13674 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013675 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013677src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13678 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13679 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13680 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013681 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013683src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13684 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13685 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13686 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013687 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013688 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013690src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13691 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13692 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13693 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013694 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013695 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
13696 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013697
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013698 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013699 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013700 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013701 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013702
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013703src_is_local : boolean
13704 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
13705 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
13706 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
13707 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
13708 client comes from (eg: require auth or https for remote machines). Please
13709 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
13710 once per connection.
13711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013712src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013713 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
13714 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
13715 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
13716 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
13717 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013719src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013720 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
13721 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13722 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
13723 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
13724 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013726src_port : integer
13727 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
13728 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
13729 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
13730 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013732src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13733 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013734 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13735 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
13736 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013737 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013739src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13740 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
13741 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13742 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13743 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013744 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013746src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13747 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
13748 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
13749 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
13750 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
13751 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
13752 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
13753 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
13754 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013755
13756 Example :
13757 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
13758 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
13759 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
13760 listen ssh
13761 bind :22
13762 mode tcp
13763 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013764 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013765 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013766 server local 127.0.0.1:22
13767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013768srv_id : integer
13769 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
13770 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
13771 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020013772
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200137737.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013774----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020013775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013776The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
13777closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
13778when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
13779usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013780future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013781
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001378251d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
13783 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13784 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13785 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
13786 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13787 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13788
13789 Example :
13790 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
13791 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
13792 # the request.
13793 frontend http-in
13794 bind *:8081
13795 default_backend servers
13796 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13797 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13798
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013799ssl_bc : boolean
13800 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13801 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
13802 other a server with the "ssl" option.
13803
13804ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
13805 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
13806 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13807
13808ssl_bc_cipher : string
13809 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
13810 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13811
13812ssl_bc_protocol : string
13813 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
13814 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13815
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013816ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013817 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013818 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13819 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013820
13821ssl_bc_session_id : binary
13822 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
13823 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
13824 if session was reused or not.
13825
13826ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
13827 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
13828 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013830ssl_c_ca_err : integer
13831 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13832 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
13833 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
13834 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
13835 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013837ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
13838 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13839 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
13840 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
13841 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013842
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013843ssl_c_der : binary
13844 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
13845 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13846 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013848ssl_c_err : integer
13849 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13850 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
13851 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
13852 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
13853 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013855ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13856 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13857 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13858 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13859 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13860 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13861 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13862 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13863 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013865ssl_c_key_alg : string
13866 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13867 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13868 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013870ssl_c_notafter : string
13871 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
13872 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13873 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013875ssl_c_notbefore : string
13876 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
13877 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13878 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013880ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13881 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13882 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13883 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13884 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13885 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13886 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13887 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13888 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013890ssl_c_serial : binary
13891 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
13892 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13893 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013895ssl_c_sha1 : binary
13896 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
13897 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
13898 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020013899 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
13900 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
13901
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013902 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020013903 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013905ssl_c_sig_alg : string
13906 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13907 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13908 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013910ssl_c_used : boolean
13911 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
13912 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013914ssl_c_verify : integer
13915 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
13916 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
13917 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
13918 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013920ssl_c_version : integer
13921 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
13922 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013923
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013924ssl_f_der : binary
13925 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
13926 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13927 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013929ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13930 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13931 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13932 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13933 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013934 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013935 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13936 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13937 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013939ssl_f_key_alg : string
13940 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13941 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
13942 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013944ssl_f_notafter : string
13945 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13946 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13947 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013949ssl_f_notbefore : string
13950 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13951 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13952 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013954ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13955 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13956 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13957 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13958 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13959 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13960 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13961 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13962 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013964ssl_f_serial : binary
13965 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13966 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13967 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013968
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020013969ssl_f_sha1 : binary
13970 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
13971 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
13972 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
13973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013974ssl_f_sig_alg : string
13975 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13976 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13977 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013979ssl_f_version : integer
13980 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13981 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13982
13983ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013984 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13985 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
13986 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
13987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013988 Example :
13989 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
13990 listen http-https
13991 bind :80
13992 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
13993 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
13994
13995ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
13996 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
13997 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13998
13999ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014000 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014001 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
14002 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
14003 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
14004 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
14005 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
14006 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
14007 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
14008 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
14009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014010ssl_fc_cipher : string
14011 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
14012 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014013
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014014ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
14015 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
14016 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014017 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014018
14019ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
14020 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
14021 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014022 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014023
14024ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
14025 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
14026 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
14027 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
14028 avaible with OpenSSL > 1.0.2 compiled with the option enable-ssl-trace.
14029 If the function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash
14030 like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
14031
14032ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
14033 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
14034 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014035 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014037ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014038 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
14039 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010014040 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
14041 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
14042 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
14043 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014045ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
14046 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020014047 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
14048 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
14049 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14050 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014051
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020014052ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020014053 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
14054 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
14055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014056ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014057 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014058 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
14059 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
14060 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14061 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
14062 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
14063 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
14064 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020014065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014066ssl_fc_protocol : string
14067 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
14068 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014069
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014070ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014071 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014072 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14073 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014075ssl_fc_session_id : binary
14076 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
14077 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
14078 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
14079 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014081ssl_fc_sni : string
14082 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
14083 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
14084 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
14085 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
14086 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
14087
14088 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
14089 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
14090 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020014091 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
14092 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014094 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014095 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
14096 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020014097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014098ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
14099 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
14100 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014101
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014102
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200141037.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014104------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014106Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
14107sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
14108only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
14109For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
14110be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
14111can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
14112sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
14113for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
14114content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014116payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
14117 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
14118 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
14119 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014121payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
14122 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
14123 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
14124 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014126req.len : integer
14127req_len : integer (deprecated)
14128 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14129 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14130 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14131 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14132 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14133 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14134 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
14135 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014136
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014137req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14138 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014139 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14140 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14141 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14142 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014144 ACL alternatives :
14145 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014146
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014147req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14148 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14149 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14150 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
14151 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014153 ACL alternatives :
14154 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014156 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014158req.proto_http : boolean
14159req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
14160 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
14161 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
14162 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
14163 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
14164 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
14165 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
14166 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014168 Example:
14169 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
14170 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14171 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014172 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014174req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
14175rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14176 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
14177 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
14178 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
14179 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
14180 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
14181 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
14182 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014184 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
14185 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
14186 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
14187 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
14188 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
14189 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014191 ACL derivatives :
14192 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014194 Example :
14195 listen tse-farm
14196 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
14197 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
14198 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14199 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
14200 # apply RDP cookie persistence
14201 persist rdp-cookie
14202 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
14203 # This is only useful makes sense if
14204 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
14205 stick-table type string size 204800
14206 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
14207 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
14208 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014210 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
14211 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014213req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
14214rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
14215 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
14216 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
14217 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
14218 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014220 ACL derivatives :
14221 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014222
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014223req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
14224 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
14225 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014226 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
14227 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
14228 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
14229 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
14230 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014232req.ssl_hello_type : integer
14233req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14234 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14235 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
14236 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14237 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14238 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
14239 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14240 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014242req.ssl_sni : string
14243req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
14244 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
14245 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
14246 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
14247 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14248 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14249 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
14250 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
14251 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
14252 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
14253 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
14254 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
14255 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014257 ACL derivatives :
14258 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014260 Examples :
14261 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
14262 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14263 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
14264 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
14265 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014266
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053014267req.ssl_st_ext : integer
14268 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
14269 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
14270 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
14271 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
14272 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
14273 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
14274 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
14275 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
14276 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
14277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014278req.ssl_ver : integer
14279req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
14280 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
14281 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
14282 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
14283 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
14284 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14285 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14286 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
14287 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
14288 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014290 ACL derivatives :
14291 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014292
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020014293res.len : integer
14294 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14295 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14296 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14297 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14298 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14299 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14300 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
14301 content inspection.
14302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014303res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14304 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014305 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14306 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14307 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14308 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014310res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14311 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14312 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14313 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
14314 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014316 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014317
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020014318res.ssl_hello_type : integer
14319rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14320 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14321 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
14322 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14323 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14324 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
14325 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14326 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
14327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014328wait_end : boolean
14329 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
14330 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
14331 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
14332 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
14333 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
14334 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
14335 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
14336 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014338 Examples :
14339 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
14340 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
14341 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014343 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
14344 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14345 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
14346 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
14347 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
14348 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
14349 tcp-request content reject
14350
14351
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200143527.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014353--------------------------------------
14354
14355It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
14356This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
14357data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
14358its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
14359HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
14360content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
14361to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
14362more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
14363response are indexed.
14364
14365base : string
14366 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
14367 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
14368 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
14369 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
14370 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
14371 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
14372 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
14373 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
14374
14375 ACL derivatives :
14376 base : exact string match
14377 base_beg : prefix match
14378 base_dir : subdir match
14379 base_dom : domain match
14380 base_end : suffix match
14381 base_len : length match
14382 base_reg : regex match
14383 base_sub : substring match
14384
14385base32 : integer
14386 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
14387 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
14388 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014389 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
14390 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
14391 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014392
14393base32+src : binary
14394 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
14395 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
14396 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
14397 per-URL counters.
14398
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014399capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
14400 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
14401 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14402 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
14403
14404capture.req.method : string
14405 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
14406 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
14407 because it's allocated.
14408
14409capture.req.uri : string
14410 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
14411 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
14412 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
14413 allocated.
14414
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014415capture.req.ver : string
14416 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14417 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
14418 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
14419
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014420capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
14421 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
14422 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14423 The first entry is an index of 0.
14424 See also: "capture response header"
14425
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014426capture.res.ver : string
14427 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14428 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
14429 persistent flag.
14430
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014431req.body : binary
14432 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
14433 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14434 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
14435 the first chunk is analyzed.
14436
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020014437req.body_param([<name>) : string
14438 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
14439 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
14440 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
14441 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
14442 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
14443 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
14444 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
14445 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
14446 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
14447 given.
14448
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014449req.body_len : integer
14450 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
14451 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
14452 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14453 "option http-buffer-request".
14454
14455req.body_size : integer
14456 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
14457 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
14458 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
14459 that the request body has been buffered made available using
14460 "option http-buffer-request".
14461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014462req.cook([<name>]) : string
14463cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14464 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14465 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14466 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
14467 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
14468 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
14469 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
14470 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
14471 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
14472
14473 ACL derivatives :
14474 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
14475 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
14476 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
14477 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
14478 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
14479 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
14480 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
14481 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014483req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14484cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14485 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14486 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014488req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14489cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14490 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14491 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
14492 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
14493 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014495cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14496 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14497 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
14498 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
14499 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014500 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014501 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
14502 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
14503 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
14504 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014506hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14507 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
14508 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
14509 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
14510 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014511 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014513req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
14514 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14515 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14516 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14517 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14518 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14519 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
14520 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
14521 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014523req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14524 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14525 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14526 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14527 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014529req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14530 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14531 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14532 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14533 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14534 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14535 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
14536 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
14537 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
14538 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
14539 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
14540 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014542 ACL derivatives :
14543 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14544 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14545 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14546 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14547 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14548 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14549 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14550 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14551
14552req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14553hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
14554 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14555 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
14556 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
14557 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
14558 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
14559 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
14560 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
14561 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
14562 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
14563
14564req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14565hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14566 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
14567 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
14568 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
14569 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14570 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14571 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14572 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
14573 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
14574
14575req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14576hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14577 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
14578 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
14579 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
14580 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14581 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14582 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14583 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
14584
14585http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
14586 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
14587 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
14588 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14589 basic auth is supported.
14590
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014591http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
14592 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
14593 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
14594 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
14595 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014596 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14597 basic auth is supported.
14598
14599 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014600 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
14601 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
14602 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
14603 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014604
14605http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014606 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
14607 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014608 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
14609 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014611method : integer + string
14612 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
14613 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
14614 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
14615 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
14616 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
14617 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
14618 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014620 ACL derivatives :
14621 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014623 Example :
14624 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
14625 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
14626 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014628path : string
14629 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
14630 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
14631 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
14632 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
14633 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
14634 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
14635 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014637 ACL derivatives :
14638 path : exact string match
14639 path_beg : prefix match
14640 path_dir : subdir match
14641 path_dom : domain match
14642 path_end : suffix match
14643 path_len : length match
14644 path_reg : regex match
14645 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014646
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014647query : string
14648 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
14649 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
14650 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
14651 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014652 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014653 which stops before the question mark.
14654
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014655req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14656 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14657 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14658 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14659 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014661req.ver : string
14662req_ver : string (deprecated)
14663 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
14664 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
14665 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014667 ACL derivatives :
14668 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014670res.comp : boolean
14671 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
14672 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
14673 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014675res.comp_algo : string
14676 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
14677 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
14678 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014680res.cook([<name>]) : string
14681scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14682 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14683 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14684 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014686 ACL derivatives :
14687 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014689res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14690scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14691 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14692 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
14693 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014695res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14696scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14697 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14698 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
14699 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014701res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14702 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14703 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14704 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14705 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14706 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
14707 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
14708 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
14709 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
14710 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014712res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14713 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14714 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14715 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14716 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
14717 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014719res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14720shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
14721 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14722 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14723 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14724 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14725 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
14726 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
14727 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
14728 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014730 ACL derivatives :
14731 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14732 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14733 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14734 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14735 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14736 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14737 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14738 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14739
14740res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14741shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14742 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14743 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14744 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
14745 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
14746 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014748res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14749shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14750 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
14751 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
14752 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
14753 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
14754 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
14755 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014756
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014757res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14758 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14759 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14760 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14761 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014763res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14764shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14765 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
14766 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14767 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14768 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14769 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
14770 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014772res.ver : string
14773resp_ver : string (deprecated)
14774 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
14775 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014777 ACL derivatives :
14778 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014780set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14781 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14782 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014783 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014784 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014786 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
14787 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014789status : integer
14790 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
14791 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
14792 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014793
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020014794unique-id : string
14795 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
14796 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
14797 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
14798 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
14799 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
14800 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
14801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014802url : string
14803 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
14804 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
14805 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
14806 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
14807 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
14808 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
14809 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014811 ACL derivatives :
14812 url : exact string match
14813 url_beg : prefix match
14814 url_dir : subdir match
14815 url_dom : domain match
14816 url_end : suffix match
14817 url_len : length match
14818 url_reg : regex match
14819 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014821url_ip : ip
14822 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
14823 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
14824 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
14825 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
14826 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
14827 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14828 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014830url_port : integer
14831 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
14832 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
14833 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14834 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014835
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014836urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
14837url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014838 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
14839 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014840 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
14841 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
14842 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
14843 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014844 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
14845 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014846 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
14847 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014849 ACL derivatives :
14850 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
14851 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
14852 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
14853 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
14854 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
14855 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
14856 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
14857 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014858
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014860 Example :
14861 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
14862 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
14863 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
14864 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014865
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014866urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014867 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
14868 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
14869 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020014870
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020014871url32 : integer
14872 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
14873 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
14874 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
14875 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
14876 is an unsigned integer.
14877
14878url32+src : binary
14879 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
14880 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
14881 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
14882
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010014883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200148847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014885---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014886
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014887Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
14888every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020014889order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014890
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014891ACL name Equivalent to Usage
14892---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014893FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020014894HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014895HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
14896HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014897HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
14898HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
14899HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
14900HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
14901LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014902METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014903METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014904METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
14905METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
14906METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
14907METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014908METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014909METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014910RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014911REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014912TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014913WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
14914---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014915
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010014916
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149178. Logging
14918----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014919
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014920One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
14921provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
14922very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
14923provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
14924state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014925to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014926headers.
14927
14928In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
14929about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
14930send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
14931
14932 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
14933 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
14934 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
14935 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
14936 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060014937 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
14938 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014939
14940The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
14941allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
14942as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
14943while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
14944real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
14945delay.
14946
14947
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149488.1. Log levels
14949---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014950
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014951TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014952source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014953HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
14954in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
14955track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
14956syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
14957about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014958
14959
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149608.2. Log formats
14961----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014962
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014963HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014964and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
14965slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
14966options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014967
14968 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
14969 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
14970 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
14971 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
14972 extents.
14973
14974 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
14975 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
14976 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
14977 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
14978 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
14979
14980 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
14981 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
14982 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
14983 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
14984 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
14985
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020014986 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
14987 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
14988 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
14989 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
14990
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014991 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
14992
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014993Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
14994specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
14995field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
14996servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
14997always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
14998identifier.
14999
15000Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
15001 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
15002 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
15003 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
15004 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
15005
15006
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150078.2.1. Default log format
15008-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015009
15010This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
15011as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
15012format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
15013
15014 Example :
15015 listen www
15016 mode http
15017 log global
15018 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15019
15020 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
15021 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
15022 (www/HTTP)
15023
15024 Field Format Extract from the example above
15025 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
15026 2 'Connect from' Connect from
15027 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
15028 4 'to' to
15029 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
15030 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
15031
15032Detailed fields description :
15033 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
15034 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
15035 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
15036 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
15037 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15038 and processed the connection.
15039 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
15040
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015041In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
15042"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
15043connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
15044
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015045It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
15046will eventually disappear.
15047
15048
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150498.2.2. TCP log format
15050---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015051
15052The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
15053is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
15054information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
15055counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
15056emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
15057environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
15058the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
15059sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015060specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
15061not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
15062fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
15063marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015064
15065 Example :
15066 frontend fnt
15067 mode tcp
15068 option tcplog
15069 log global
15070 default_backend bck
15071
15072 backend bck
15073 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15074
15075 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
15076 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
15077 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
15078
15079 Field Format Extract from the example above
15080 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
15081 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
15082 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
15083 4 frontend_name fnt
15084 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
15085 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
15086 7 bytes_read* 212
15087 8 termination_state --
15088 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
15089 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15090
15091Detailed fields description :
15092 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015093 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15094 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15095 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015096 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15097 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15098 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015099
15100 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015101 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15102 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15103 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015104
15105 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
15106 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
15107 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
15108 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
15109
15110 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15111 and processed the connection.
15112
15113 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15114 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15115 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
15116 applications.
15117
15118 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15119 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15120 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15121 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
15122 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
15123
15124 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15125 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15126 See "Timers" below for more details.
15127
15128 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15129 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15130 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
15131 "Timers" below for more details.
15132
15133 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015134 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015135 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
15136 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
15137 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
15138 details.
15139
15140 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
15141 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
15142 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
15143 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
15144 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
15145
15146 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15147 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15148 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
15149 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
15150 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
15151 for more details.
15152
15153 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015154 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015155 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
15156 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
15157 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015158 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015159
15160 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15161 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15162 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15163 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15164 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15165 caused by a denial of service attack.
15166
15167 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15168 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15169 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15170 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15171 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15172 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15173 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15174 denial of service attack.
15175
15176 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15177 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15178 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15179 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15180 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15181 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15182 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15183 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
15184 be processed than on other servers.
15185
15186 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15187 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15188 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15189 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15190 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15191 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15192 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15193 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15194 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15195 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15196 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15197 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15198 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15199
15200 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15201 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15202 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15203 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15204 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15205 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15206 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15207 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15208
15209 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15210 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15211 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15212 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15213 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15214 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15215 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15216 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15217 occurs.
15218
15219
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152208.2.3. HTTP log format
15221----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015222
15223The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
15224is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
15225the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
15226are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
15227emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
15228generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
15229"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
15230which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015231frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
15232is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015233
15234Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
15235slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
15236with a star ('*') after the field name below.
15237
15238 Example :
15239 frontend http-in
15240 mode http
15241 option httplog
15242 log global
15243 default_backend bck
15244
15245 backend static
15246 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15247
15248 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
15249 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
15250 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015251 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015252
15253 Field Format Extract from the example above
15254 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
15255 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015256 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015257 4 frontend_name http-in
15258 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015259 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015260 7 status_code 200
15261 8 bytes_read* 2750
15262 9 captured_request_cookie -
15263 10 captured_response_cookie -
15264 11 termination_state ----
15265 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
15266 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15267 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
15268 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
15269 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015270
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015271Detailed fields description :
15272 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015273 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15274 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15275 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015276 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15277 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15278 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015279
15280 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015281 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15282 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15283 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015284
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015285 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
15286 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015287
15288 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15289 and processed the connection.
15290
15291 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15292 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15293 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
15294
15295 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15296 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15297 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15298 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
15299 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
15300 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
15301
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015302 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
15303 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
15304 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
15305 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
15306 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
15307 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
15308 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015309
15310 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15311 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15312 See "Timers" below for more details.
15313
15314 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15315 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15316 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
15317 below for more details.
15318
15319 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
15320 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
15321 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
15322 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
15323 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
15324 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
15325 for more details.
15326
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015327 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
15328 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
15329 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
15330 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
15331 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
15332 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
15333 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
15334 See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015335
15336 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
15337 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
15338 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
15339
15340 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
15341 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
15342 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
15343 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
15344 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
15345 overflowing.
15346
15347 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
15348 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
15349 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
15350 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
15351 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
15352 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
15353 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
15354 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15355
15356 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
15357 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
15358 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
15359 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
15360 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
15361 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
15362 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
15363 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15364
15365 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15366 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15367 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
15368 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
15369 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
15370 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
15371 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
15372
15373 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015374 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015375 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
15376 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
15377 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015378 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015379 system.
15380
15381 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15382 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15383 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15384 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15385 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15386 caused by a denial of service attack.
15387
15388 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15389 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15390 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15391 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15392 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15393 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15394 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15395 denial of service attack.
15396
15397 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15398 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15399 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15400 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15401 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15402 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15403 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15404 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
15405 processed than on other servers.
15406
15407 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15408 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15409 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15410 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15411 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15412 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15413 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15414 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15415 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15416 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15417 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15418 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15419 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15420
15421 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15422 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15423 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15424 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15425 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15426 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15427 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15428 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15429
15430 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15431 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15432 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15433 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15434 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15435 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15436 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15437 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15438 occurs.
15439
15440 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
15441 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
15442 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
15443 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
15444 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
15445 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
15446 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
15447 cookies" below for more details.
15448
15449 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
15450 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
15451 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
15452 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
15453 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
15454 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
15455 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
15456 and cookies" below for more details.
15457
15458 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
15459 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
15460 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
15461 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
15462 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
15463 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
15464 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
15465 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
15466
15467
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200154688.2.4. Custom log format
15469------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015470
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015471The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015472mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015473
15474HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
15475Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
15476separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
15477prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
15478
15479Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
15480variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015481("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015482
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015483If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020015484as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015485less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
15486the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
15487
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015488Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015489In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010015490in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015491
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015492Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
15493'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
15494https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
15495such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
15496
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015497Flags are :
15498 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015499 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015500 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
15501 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015502
15503 Example:
15504
15505 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
15506 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
15507
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015508 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
15509
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015510At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
15511
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015512 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
15513 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015514
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015515the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015516
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015517 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
15518 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
15519 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015520
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015521and the default TCP format is defined this way :
15522
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015523 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
15524 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015525
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015526Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
15527
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015528 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015529 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015530 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
15531 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
15532 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015533 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
15534 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
15535 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015536 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015537 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
15538 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000015539 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015540 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
15541 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010015542 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020015543 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015544 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015545 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015546 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020015547 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080015548 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015549 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
15550 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
15551 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
15552 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
15553 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015554 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015555 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
15556 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015557 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015558 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
15559 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015560 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15561 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
15562 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015563 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015564 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
15565 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015566 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015567 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15568 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
15569 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020015570 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020015571 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015572 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
15573 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
15574 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
15575 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020015576 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015577 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015578 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015579 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010015580 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015581 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015582 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
15583 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
15584 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015585 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015586 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
15587 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015588 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015589 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
15590 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
15591 | H | %trl | locla_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015592 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015593 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015594 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015595
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015596 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015597
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010015598
155998.2.5. Error log format
15600-----------------------
15601
15602When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
15603protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
15604By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
15605"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
15606will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
15607logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
15608
15609The format looks like this :
15610
15611 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
15612 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
15613 Connection error during SSL handshake
15614
15615 Field Format Extract from the example above
15616 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
15617 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
15618 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
15619 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
15620 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
15621
15622These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
15623failures.
15624
15625
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156268.3. Advanced logging options
15627-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015628
15629Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
15630just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
15631options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
15632for more information about their usage.
15633
15634
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156358.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
15636------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015637
15638It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
15639haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
15640commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
15641monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
15642ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
15643
15644 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
15645 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
15646 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
15647 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
15648
15649 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
15650 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
15651 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015652 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015653 such as other load-balancers.
15654
15655 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
15656 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
15657 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
15658
15659
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156608.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
15661----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015662
15663The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
15664what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
15665or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
15666"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
15667just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
15668log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
15669after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
15670is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
15671with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
15672with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
15673
15674
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156758.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
15676------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015677
15678Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
15679for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
15680"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
15681retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
15682raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
15683a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
15684file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
15685you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
15686"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
15687
15688
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156898.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
15690--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015691
15692Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
15693multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
15694them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
15695"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
15696logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
15697error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
15698and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
15699too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
15700useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
15701alternative.
15702
15703
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157048.4. Timing events
15705------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015706
15707Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
15708reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
15709the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
15710frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015711mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
15712addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
15713
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010015714Timings events in HTTP mode:
15715
15716 first request 2nd request
15717 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
15718 t tr t tr ...
15719 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
15720 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
15721 :<---- Tq ---->: :
15722 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
15723 :<--------- Ta --------->:
15724
15725Timings events in TCP mode:
15726
15727 TCP session
15728 |<----------------->|
15729 t t
15730 ---|----|----|----|----|---
15731 | Th Tw Tc Td |
15732 |<------ Tt ------->|
15733
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015734 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
15735 protocols. Currently, these protocoles are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
15736 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
15737 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
15738 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
15739 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (eg: MTU issues), or that an
15740 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015741
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015742 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
15743 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
15744 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
15745 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. Some
15746 browsers pre-establish connections to a server in order to reduce the
15747 latency of a future request, and keep them pending until they need it. This
15748 delay will be reported as the idle time. A value of -1 indicates that
15749 nothing was received on the connection.
15750
15751 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
15752 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
15753 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
15754 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
15755 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
15756 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
15757 request typed by hand during a test.
15758
15759 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
15760 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
15761 exactly equalt to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
15762 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
15763 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
15764 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
15765 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015766
15767 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
15768 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
15769 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
15770 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
15771 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
15772
15773 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
15774 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
15775 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
15776 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
15777 connection never established.
15778
15779 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
15780 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
15781 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
15782 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
15783 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
15784 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
15785 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
15786 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
15787 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
15788 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
15789 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
15790
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015791 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
15792 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
15793 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
15794 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
15795 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
15796 by subtracting other timers when valid :
15797
15798 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
15799
15800 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
15801 "Ta" can never be negative.
15802
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015803 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
15804 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015805 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
15806 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015807 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015808
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015809 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015810
15811 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015812 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
15813 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015814
15815These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
15816protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
15817that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015818due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
15819"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
15820that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015821
15822Most common cases :
15823
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015824 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
15825 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
15826 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
15827 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
15828 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
15829 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
15830 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
15831 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
15832 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
15833 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
15834 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020015835 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015836
15837 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
15838 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
15839 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
15840 of ms on remote networks.
15841
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015842 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
15843 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
15844 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015845
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015846 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
15847 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
15848 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
15849 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
15850 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
15851 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
15852 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
15853 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
15854 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015855
15856Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
15857
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015858 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015859 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015860 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015861
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015862 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015863 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
15864 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
15865
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015866 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015867 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
15868 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
15869 flags.
15870
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015871 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
15872 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015873 Check the session termination flags, then check the
15874 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
15875 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
15876 the client connection was maintained open.
15877
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015878 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015879 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015880 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015881 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
15882
15883
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158848.5. Session state at disconnection
15885-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015886
15887TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
15888"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
158892-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
15890each of which has a special meaning :
15891
15892 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
15893 session to terminate :
15894
15895 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
15896
15897 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
15898 server explicitly refused it.
15899
15900 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
15901 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
15902 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
15903 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015904 (eg: cacheable cookie).
15905
15906 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
15907 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015908
15909 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
15910 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
15911 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
15912 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
15913 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
15914
15915 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
15916 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
15917 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
15918 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
15919 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
15920
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090015921 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
15922 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
15923
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015924 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
15925 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
15926 backup connections when going up.
15927
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020015928 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
15929
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015930 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
15931 send or receive data.
15932
15933 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
15934 send or receive data.
15935
15936 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
15937 with nothing left in the buffers.
15938
15939 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
15940
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010015941 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015942 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
15943
15944 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
15945 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
15946 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
15947 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
15948 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
15949
15950 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
15951 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
15952
15953 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
15954 server (HTTP only).
15955
15956 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
15957
15958 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
15959 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
15960 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
15961
15962 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
15963 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
15964 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
15965
15966 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
15967
15968 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
15969 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
15970
15971 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
15972 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
15973 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
15974
15975 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
15976 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020015977 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
15978 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015979
15980 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
15981 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
15982 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
15983 another server.
15984
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015985 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015986 server.
15987
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015988 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
15989 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
15990 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
15991 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15992
15993 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
15994 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
15995 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
15996 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15997
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020015998 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
15999 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
16000 "use-server" rule).
16001
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016002 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16003
16004 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
16005 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
16006
16007 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
16008
16009 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
16010 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
16011 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
16012
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016013 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
16014 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016015 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016016 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
16017 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
16018
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016019 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
16020
16021 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
16022 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
16023
16024 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
16025
16026 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16027
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016028The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
16029was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016030helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
16031starvation, attacks, etc...
16032
16033The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
16034alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
16035easier finding and understanding.
16036
16037 Flags Reason
16038
16039 -- Normal termination.
16040
16041 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
16042 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
16043 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
16044 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
16045
16046 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
16047 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
16048 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
16049 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
16050 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
16051 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016052
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016053 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16054 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016055 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016056
16057 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
16058 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
16059 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
16060
16061 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
16062 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
16063 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
16064 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
16065 the server takes too long to respond.
16066
16067 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
16068 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
16069 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
16070 long a time to respond.
16071
16072 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
16073 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
16074 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
16075 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016076 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
16077 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016078
16079 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
16080 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
16081 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
16082 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
16083 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020016084 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016085 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
16086 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
16087 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
16088 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
16089 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
16090 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
16091 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
16092 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
16093 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
16094 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
16095 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
16096 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016097
16098 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
16099 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016100 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
16101 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
16102 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
16103 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016104
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016105 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
16106 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
16107
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016108 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016109 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
16110 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
16111 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
16112 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
16113 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
16114
16115 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
16116 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
16117 503 or 504 here.
16118
16119 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
16120 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
16121 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
16122 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
16123 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
16124
16125 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16126 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016127 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016128 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
16129 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
16130
16131 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
16132 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
16133 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
16134 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
16135 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
16136 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
16137 between haproxy and the server.
16138
16139 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
16140 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
16141 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
16142 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
16143 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
16144 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
16145 solution is to fix the application.
16146
16147 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
16148 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
16149 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
16150 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
16151 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
16152 external attacks.
16153
16154 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
16155 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016156 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016157 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
16158 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
16159
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016160 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
16161 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
16162 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020016163 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
16164 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016165
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016166 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
16167 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
16168 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
16169 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016170 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
16171 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
16172 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
16173 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
16174 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016175
16176 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
16177 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
16178 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
16179 returned an HTTP 403 error.
16180
16181 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
16182 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
16183 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
16184 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
16185
16186 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
16187 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
16188 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
16189 only be solved by proper system tuning.
16190
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016191The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
16192persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
16193important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
16194re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
16195
16196 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
16197
16198 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16199 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
16200 set on a GET request.
16201
16202 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
16203 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016204 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016205 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
16206
16207 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
16208 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
16209 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
16210
16211 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16212 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
16213 already got a cookie.
16214
16215 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16216 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
16217 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
16218 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
16219 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
16220
16221 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16222 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16223 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16224
16225 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
16226 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16227 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16228
16229 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
16230 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
16231
16232 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
16233 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
16234 then advertised in the response.
16235
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016236
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162378.6. Non-printable characters
16238-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016239
16240In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
16241consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
16242converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
16243prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
16244being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
16245escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
16246is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
16247'}' when logging headers.
16248
16249Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
16250issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
16251containing spaces is "User-Agent".
16252
16253Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
16254the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
16255performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
16256
16257
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162588.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
16259---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016260
16261Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
16262achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016263section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016264cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
16265the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
16266the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016267locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016268not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
16269user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
16270a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
16271wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
16272
16273 Examples :
16274 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
16275 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
16276
16277 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
16278 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
16279
16280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162818.8. Capturing HTTP headers
16282---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016283
16284Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
16285proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
16286the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
16287server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
16288
16289Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
16290response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016291section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016292
16293It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016294time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
16295appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016296are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
16297and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
16298follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
16299request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
16300in the logs.
16301
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016302As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
16303frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
16304an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
16305
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016306 Example :
16307 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
16308 listen proxy-out
16309 mode http
16310 option httplog
16311 option logasap
16312 log global
16313 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
16314
16315 # log the name of the virtual server
16316 capture request header Host len 20
16317
16318 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
16319 capture request header Content-Length len 10
16320
16321 # log the beginning of the referrer
16322 capture request header Referer len 20
16323
16324 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
16325 capture response header Server len 20
16326
16327 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
16328 capture response header Content-Length len 10
16329
16330 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
16331 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
16332
16333 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
16334 capture response header Via len 20
16335
16336 # log the URL location during a redirection
16337 capture response header Location len 20
16338
16339 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
16340 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
16341 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16342 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
16343 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
16344
16345 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16346 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16347 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16348 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016349 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016350
16351 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16352 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16353 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16354 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
16355 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016356 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016357
16358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163598.9. Examples of logs
16360---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016361
16362These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
16363them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
16364reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
16365
16366 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
16367 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16368 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16369
16370 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
16371 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
16372
16373 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
16374 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
16375 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16376
16377 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
16378 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
16379
16380 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
16381 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16382 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
16383
16384 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016385 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016386 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
16387 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
16388
16389 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
16390 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
16391 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
16392
16393 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
16394 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020016395 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016396 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
16397 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
16398 to return the 502 and not the server.
16399
16400 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016401 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016402
16403 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
16404 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
16405 Nothing was sent to any server.
16406
16407 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
16408 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
16409
16410 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
16411 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
16412 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
16413 send a 408 return code to the client.
16414
16415 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
16416 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
16417
16418 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
16419 5 seconds ("c----").
16420
16421 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
16422 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016423 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016424
16425 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016426 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016427 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
16428 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
16429 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
16430 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
16431 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016432
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020016433
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200164349. Supported filters
16435--------------------
16436
16437Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
16438accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
16439unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
16440
16441See also : "filter"
16442
164439.1. Trace
16444----------
16445
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016446filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016447
16448 Arguments:
16449 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
16450 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
16451
16452 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
16453 the client and the server. By default, this filter
16454 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
16455 only parses a random amount of the available data.
16456
16457 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwading of parsed data. By
16458 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
16459 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
16460 amount of the parsed data.
16461
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016462 <hexump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
16463
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016464This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
16465callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
16466information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
16467filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
16468
16469Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
16470tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
16471a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
16472
16473
164749.2. HTTP compression
16475---------------------
16476
16477filter compression
16478
16479The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
16480keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
16481when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
16482use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
16483used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
16484filters evaluation order.
16485
16486See also : "compression"
16487
16488
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200164899.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
16490--------------------------------------------
16491
16492filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
16493
16494 Arguments :
16495
16496 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
16497 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
16498 parsed.
16499
16500 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
16501 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
16502 part must be placed in its own scope.
16503
16504The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
16505external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
16506streams in tierce applications. These external components and information
16507exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
16508also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
16509
16510SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
16511the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
16512
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016513For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020016514"doc/SPOE.txt".
16515
16516Important note:
16517 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
16518 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
16519
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016520/*
16521 * Local variables:
16522 * fill-column: 79
16523 * End:
16524 */